blob: 52f9502d74cc69a6f7228cee1c2da4398eb0cd92 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000183 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000184 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000185 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000186 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000188 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
190 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
191 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000192 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
193 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000194 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
195 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
196 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000197 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
198 Instruction *LHS,
199 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000200 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
201 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000202
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000203 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
204 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000205 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000206 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000207 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000209 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000210 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000214 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000215 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
216 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000217 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
218 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
219 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000220 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000221 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000222 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
223 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000224 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
225 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000226 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
227 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000228 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
229 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000230 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000231 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000232 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000233 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000234 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000235 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000236 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000238 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000239 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000240
241 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000242 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000243
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000245 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000246 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000247 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000248 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
249 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000250 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000251
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000252 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000253 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
254 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
255 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000256 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000257 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
258 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000259 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
260 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000261 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000262 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000263 }
264
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000265 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
266 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
267 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000268 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
269 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000270 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000271
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000273 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000274
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000275 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000276 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000277 return C;
278 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000279
280 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
281 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
282 }
283
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000284
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
286 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
287 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
288 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
289 // modified.
290 //
291 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000292 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000293 if (&I != V) {
294 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
295 return &I;
296 } else {
297 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
298 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000299 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000300 return &I;
301 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000302 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000303
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000304 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
305 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
306 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
307 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
308 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
309 //
310 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
311 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
312 if (Old != New)
313 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000316 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000317 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000318 return true;
319 }
320
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000321 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
322 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
323 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
324 // this function.
325 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
326 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
327 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000328 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000329 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000330 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
331 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000332
333 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
334 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
335 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
336 }
337
338 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
339 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
340 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
341 }
342 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
343 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
344 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000345
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000346 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000347 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
348 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
349 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
350 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000351 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
352 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000353 Instruction *InsertBefore);
354
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000355 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
356 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000357 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000358
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000359 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
360 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
361 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
362
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000363 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
364 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000365 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
366 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
367 unsigned Depth = 0);
368
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000369 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
370 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
371
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000372 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
373 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
374 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
375 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
376
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000377 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
378 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
379 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
380 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000381 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
382
383
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000384 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
385 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000387 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000388 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000389 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000390 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000391 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000392 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000393 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000395 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000396
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000397
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000398 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000399
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000400 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
401 unsigned CastOpc,
402 int &NumCastsRemoved);
403 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
404 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000405
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000406 };
407}
408
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000409char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
410static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
411X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
412
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000414// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000415static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
416 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
417 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000418 return 3;
419 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000420 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000421 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
422 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000423}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000424
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000425// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
426// it.
427static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000428 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000429}
430
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000431// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
432// though a va_arg area...
433static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000434 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
435 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
436 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000437 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000438 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000439}
440
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000441/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
442/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
443/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000444static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
445 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000447 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000448 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
449 // GetElementPtrInst?
450 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
451 return GEP->getOperand(0);
452 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000453 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000455 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000456 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
457 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
458 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
459 I != E; ++I) {
460 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
461 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
462 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
463 return 0;
464 }
465 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
466 return CE->getOperand(0);
467 }
468 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000469 return 0;
470}
471
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
473/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000474static Instruction::CastOps
475isEliminableCastPair(
476 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
477 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
478 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
479 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
480) {
481
482 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
483 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000484
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000485 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
486 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
487 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000488
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000489 return Instruction::CastOps(
490 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
491 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000492}
493
494/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
495/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
496/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000497static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
498 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000499 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
500
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000501 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000503 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000504 return false;
505 return true;
506}
507
508/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
509/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
510/// casts that are known to not do anything...
511///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000512Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
513 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000514 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
515 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
516 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000519 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000520}
521
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000522// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
523// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000524//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000525// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
526// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
527// binary operators.
528//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000529// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
530// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000532bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000533 bool Changed = false;
534 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
535 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000536
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000537 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
538 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
540 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
541 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000542 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
543 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
544 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000545 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
546 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
547 return true;
548 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
549 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
550 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
551 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
552 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
553
554 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000555 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000556 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000557 Op1->getOperand(0),
558 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000559 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000560 I.setOperand(0, New);
561 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
562 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000563 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000564 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000565 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000566}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000567
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000568/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
569/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
570/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
571bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
572 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
573 return false;
574 I.swapOperands();
575 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
576 return true;
577}
578
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000579// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
580// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000581//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000582static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
583 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000584 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000585
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000586 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
587 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
588 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000589
590 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
591 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
592 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
593
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000594 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000595}
596
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000597static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
598 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000599 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000600
601 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000602 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000603 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000604 return 0;
605}
606
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000607// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
608// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000609// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
610// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000611//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000613 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000614 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000616 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000617 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000619 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000620 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000622 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000623 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000624 return I->getOperand(0);
625 }
626 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000627 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000628}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000629
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000630/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
631/// expression, return it.
632static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
633 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
634 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
635 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
636 return cast<User>(V);
637 return false;
638}
639
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000640/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
641/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000642static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
643 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000645 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000646 return CE->getOpcode();
647 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
648 return Instruction::UserOp1;
649}
650
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000651/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000652static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000653 APInt Val(C->getValue());
654 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000655}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000656/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000657static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000658 APInt Val(C->getValue());
659 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000660}
661/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
662static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
663 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
664}
665/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
666static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
667 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
668}
669/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
670static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
671 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
672}
673/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
674static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
675 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000676}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000677/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
678/// this size.
679static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
680 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
681 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
682 if (sign) {
683 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
684 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
685 } else {
686 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
687 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
688 }
689
690 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
691
692 if (sign) {
693 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
694 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
695 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
696 } else
697 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
698}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000699
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000700
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000701/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
702/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
703/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
704/// constant and return true.
705static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000706 APInt Demanded) {
707 assert(I && "No instruction?");
708 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
709
710 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
711 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
712 if (!OpC) return false;
713
714 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
715 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
716 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
717 return false;
718
719 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
720 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
721 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
722 return true;
723}
724
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
726// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
727// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
728// min/max.
729static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000730 const APInt& KnownZero,
731 const APInt& KnownOne,
732 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
733 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
734 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
736 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
737 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000738 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000739
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000740 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
741 // bit if it is unknown.
742 Min = KnownOne;
743 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
744
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000745 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000746 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
747 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000748 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000749}
750
751// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
752// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
753// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
754// min/max.
755static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000756 const APInt &KnownZero,
757 const APInt &KnownOne,
758 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
759 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000760 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
761 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
762 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
763 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000764 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000765
766 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
767 Min = KnownOne;
768 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
769 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
770}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000771
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000772/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
773/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
774/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
775/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
776/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
777/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
778/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
779/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
780/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
781/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
782/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
783/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
784/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
785/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
786/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
787bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
788 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
789 unsigned Depth) {
790 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
791 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
792 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
793 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
794 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
796 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
797 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
798 must have same BitWidth");
799 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
800 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
801 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
802 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
803 return false;
804 }
805
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000806 KnownZero.clear();
807 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000808 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
809 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
810 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
811 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
812 return false;
813 }
814 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
815 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
816 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
817 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
818 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
819 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
820 return false;
821 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
822 return false;
823 }
824
825 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
826 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
827
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000828 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
829 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
830 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000831 default:
832 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
833 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000834 case Instruction::And:
835 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
836 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
837 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
838 return true;
839 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
840 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
841
842 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
843 // LHS.
844 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
845 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
846 return true;
847 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
848 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
849
850 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
851 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
852 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
853 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
854 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
855 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
856 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
857 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
858
859 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
860 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
861 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
862
863 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
864 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
865 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
866
867 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
868 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
869 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
870 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
871 break;
872 case Instruction::Or:
873 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
874 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
875 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
876 return true;
877 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
878 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
879 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
880 // LHS.
881 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
882 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
883 return true;
884 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
885 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
886
887 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
888 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
889 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
890 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
891 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
892 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
893 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
894 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
895
896 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
897 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
898 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
899 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
900 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
901 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
902 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
903 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
904
905 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
906 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
907 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
908
909 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
910 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
911 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
912 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
913 break;
914 case Instruction::Xor: {
915 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
916 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
917 return true;
918 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
919 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
920 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
921 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
922 return true;
923 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
924 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
925
926 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
927 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
928 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
930 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
931 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
932
933 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
934 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
935 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
936 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
937 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
938 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
939
940 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
941 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
942 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
943 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
944 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000945 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946 I->getName());
947 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
948 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
949 }
950
951 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
952 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
953 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
954 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
955 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
956 // all known
957 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
958 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
959 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000960 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000961 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
962 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
963 }
964 }
965
966 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
967 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
968 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
969 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
970
971 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
972 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
973 break;
974 }
975 case Instruction::Select:
976 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
977 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
978 return true;
979 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
980 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
981 return true;
982 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
985 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
986
987 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
991 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
992
993 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
994 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
995 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
996 break;
997 case Instruction::Trunc: {
998 uint32_t truncBf =
999 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001000 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1001 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1002 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1003 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1004 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001005 return true;
1006 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1008 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1009 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1010 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1011 break;
1012 }
1013 case Instruction::BitCast:
1014 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1015 return false;
1016
1017 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1018 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1019 return true;
1020 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1021 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1022 break;
1023 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1024 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1025 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001026 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001028 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1029 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1030 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001031 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1032 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001033 return true;
1034 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1036 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1037 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1038 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1039 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001040 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001041 break;
1042 }
1043 case Instruction::SExt: {
1044 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1045 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001046 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001047
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001051 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1053 // bit is demanded.
1054 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001056
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001057 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1058 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1059 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001060 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1061 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001062 return true;
1063 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1064 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1065 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1066 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1067 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1068
1069 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1070 // top bits of the result.
1071
1072 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1073 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001074 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001075 {
1076 // Convert to ZExt cast
1077 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1078 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001079 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001080 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001081 }
1082 break;
1083 }
1084 case Instruction::Add: {
1085 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1086 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1087 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001088 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001089
1090 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1091 // we can do.
1092 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1093 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1094 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1095 if (RHS->isZero())
1096 break;
1097
1098 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1099 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001100 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001101
1102 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1103 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1104 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1105 return true;
1106
1107 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1108 // the constant.
1109 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1110 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1111
1112 // Avoid excess work.
1113 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1114 break;
1115
1116 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1117 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1118 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001119 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001120 I->getName());
1121 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1122 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1123 }
1124
1125 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1126 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1127 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1128 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1129 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1130
1131 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1132 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1133 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001134 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1135 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001136
1137 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1138
1139 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1140 // other, and there is no input carry.
1141 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1142 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1143
1144 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1145 // is no input carry.
1146 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1147 } else {
1148 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1149 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001150 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001151 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1152 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001153 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001154 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1155 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1156 return true;
1157 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1158 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1159 return true;
1160 }
1161 }
1162 break;
1163 }
1164 case Instruction::Sub:
1165 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1166 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001167 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001168 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1169 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001170 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001171 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1173 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1174 return true;
1175 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1176 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1177 return true;
1178 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001179 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1180 // the known zeros and ones.
1181 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001182 break;
1183 case Instruction::Shl:
1184 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001185 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001186 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1187 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1189 return true;
1190 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1191 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1192 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1193 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1194 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001195 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001196 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 }
1198 break;
1199 case Instruction::LShr:
1200 // For a logical shift right
1201 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001202 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001203
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001204 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001205 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1206 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001207 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1208 return true;
1209 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1210 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001211 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1212 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001213 if (ShiftAmt) {
1214 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001215 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001216 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1217 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218 }
1219 break;
1220 case Instruction::AShr:
1221 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1222 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1223 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1224 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1225 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1226 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001227 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001228 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1229 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1230 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1231 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001232
1233 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1234 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1235 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1236 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001237
1238 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001239 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001240
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001241 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001242 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001243 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1244 // demanded.
1245 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1246 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001248 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001249 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1250 return true;
1251 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1252 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1253 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001254 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001255 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1256 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1257
1258 // Handle the sign bits.
1259 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1260 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1261 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1262
1263 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1264 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001265 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001266 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1267 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001268 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001269 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1270 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1271 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1272 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1273 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1274 }
1275 }
1276 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001277 case Instruction::SRem:
1278 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001279 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1280 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001281 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1282 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1283
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001284 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001285 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1286 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1287 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1288 return true;
1289
1290 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1291 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001294
1295 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1296 }
1297 }
1298 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001299 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001300 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1301 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001302 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1303 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1304 return true;
1305
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001307 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001308 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1309 return true;
1310
1311 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1312 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1313 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001314 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001315 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001316 case Instruction::Call:
1317 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1318 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1319 default: break;
1320 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1321 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1322 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1323 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1324 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1325
1326 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1327 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1328 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1329 NLZ &= ~7;
1330 NTZ &= ~7;
1331 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1332 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1333 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1334 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1335
1336 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1337 // the right place.
1338 Instruction *NewVal;
1339 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1340 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1341 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1342 else
1343 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1344 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1345 NewVal->takeName(I);
1346 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1347 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1348 }
1349
1350 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1351 break;
1352 }
1353 }
1354 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001355 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001356 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001357 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001358
1359 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1360 // constant.
1361 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1362 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1363 return false;
1364}
1365
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001366
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001367/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001368/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1369/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1370/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1371///
1372/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1373/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1374/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1375Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1376 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1377 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001378 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001379 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1380 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001381 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001382
1383 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1384 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1385 UndefElts = EltMask;
1386 return 0;
1387 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1388 UndefElts = EltMask;
1389 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1390 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001391
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001392 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001393 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1394 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001395 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1396
1397 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1398 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1399 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1400 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1401 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1402 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1403 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1404 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1405 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1406 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1407 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001408
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001410 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001411 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1412 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001413 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001414 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001415
1416 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1417 // anything.
1418 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1419 return 0;
1420
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001421 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001422 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1423 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1424 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1425 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1426 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1427 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001428 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 }
1430
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001431 // Limit search depth.
1432 if (Depth == 10)
1433 return false;
1434
1435 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1436 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1437 // are needed.
1438 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1439 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1440 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1441 // the main instcombine process.
1442 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001443 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1444 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001445
1446 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1447 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001448 }
1449
1450 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1451 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1452
1453 bool MadeChange = false;
1454 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1455 Value *TmpV;
1456 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1457 default: break;
1458
1459 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1460 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1461 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001462 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001463 if (Idx == 0) {
1464 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1465 // which elt is getting updated.
1466 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1467 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1468 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1469 break;
1470 }
1471
1472 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1473 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001474 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001475 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1476 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1477
1478 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1479 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1480 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1481 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1482 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1483 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1484
1485 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001486 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1487 break;
1488 }
1489 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1490 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001491 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1492 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001493 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1494 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1495 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1496 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1497 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001498 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001499 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001500 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001501 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1502 else
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001503 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001504 }
1505 }
1506 }
1507
1508 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1509 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1510 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1511
1512 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1513 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1514 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1515 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1516
1517 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1518 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1519 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001520 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001521 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1522 UndefElts |= NewBit;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001523 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001524 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1525 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1526 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1527 } else {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001528 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - LHSVWidth)) & 1) << i;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001529 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1530 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1531 }
1532 }
1533
1534 if (NewUndefElts) {
1535 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1536 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1537 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1538 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1539 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1540 else
1541 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1542 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1543 }
1544 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1545 MadeChange = true;
1546 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001547 break;
1548 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001549 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001550 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001551 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1552 if (!VTy) break;
1553 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1554 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1555 unsigned Ratio;
1556
1557 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001558 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001559 // elements as are demanded of us.
1560 Ratio = 1;
1561 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1562 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1563 // Untested so far.
1564 break;
1565
1566 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1567 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1568 // elements are live.
1569 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1570 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1571 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1572 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1573 }
1574 } else {
1575 // Untested so far.
1576 break;
1577
1578 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1579 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1580 // live.
1581 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1582 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1583 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1584 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1585 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001586
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001587 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1588 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1589 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1590 if (TmpV) {
1591 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1592 MadeChange = true;
1593 }
1594
1595 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1596 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1597 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1598 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1599 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1600 // undef.
1601 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1602 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1603 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1604 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1605 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1606 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1607 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1608 // elements are undef.
1609 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1610 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1611 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1612 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1613 }
1614 break;
1615 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001616 case Instruction::And:
1617 case Instruction::Or:
1618 case Instruction::Xor:
1619 case Instruction::Add:
1620 case Instruction::Sub:
1621 case Instruction::Mul:
1622 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1623 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1624 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1625 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1626 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1627 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1628 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1629
1630 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1631 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1632 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1633 break;
1634
1635 case Instruction::Call: {
1636 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1637 if (!II) break;
1638 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1639 default: break;
1640
1641 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1642 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1643 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1644 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1647 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1648 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1649 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1650 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1651 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1652 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1653 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1654 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1655 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1656 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1657
1658 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1659 // scalarize it now.
1660 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1661 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1662 default: break;
1663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1664 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1665 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1666 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1667 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1668 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1669 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1670 // Extract the element as scalars.
1671 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1672 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1673
1674 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1675 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1676 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1677 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001678 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001679 II->getName()), *II);
1680 break;
1681 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1682 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001683 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001684 II->getName()), *II);
1685 break;
1686 }
1687
1688 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001689 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1690 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001691 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1692 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1693 return New;
1694 }
1695 }
1696
1697 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1698 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1699 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1700 break;
1701 }
1702 break;
1703 }
1704 }
1705 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1706}
1707
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001708
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001709/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1710/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1711/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1712/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1713/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1714/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1715/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1716///
1717template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001718static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001719 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1720 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1721
1722 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1723 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1724 return F.apply(Root);
1725
1726 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1727 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001728 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001729 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1730 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1731
1732 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1733 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1734 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1735 ShouldApply = true;
1736 }
1737
1738 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1739 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1740 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001741 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1742 // and perform the reassociation.
1743 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1744
1745 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1746 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1747
1748 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1749 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001750 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001751 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1752 return 0;
1753 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001755 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001756 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001757 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001758 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759
1760 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1761 // get to LHSI.
1762 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1763 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001764 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1765 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001766 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001767 ARI = NextLHSI;
1768
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001769 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1770 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1771 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1772 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1773 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001774
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001775 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1776 // the transformation...
1777 return F.apply(Root);
1778 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001779
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001780 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1781 }
1782 return 0;
1783}
1784
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001785namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001786
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001787// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001788struct AddRHS {
1789 Value *RHS;
1790 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1791 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1792 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001793 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1794 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001795 }
1796};
1797
1798// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1799// iff C1&C2 == 0
1800struct AddMaskingAnd {
1801 Constant *C2;
1802 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1803 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001804 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001805 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001806 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001807 }
1808 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001809 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001810 }
1811};
1812
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001813}
1814
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001815static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001816 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001817 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001818 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001819 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001820
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001821 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001822 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001823 }
1824
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001825 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001826 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1827 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001828
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001829 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1830 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001831 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1832 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001833 }
1834
1835 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1836 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1837 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1838 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001839 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001840 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001841 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001842 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001843 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001844 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001845 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001846 abort();
1847 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001848 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1849}
1850
1851// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1852// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1853// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1854// not have a second operand.
1855static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1856 InstCombiner *IC) {
1857 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1858 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1859 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1860 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1861
1862 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001863 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001864 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001865
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001866 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1867 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1868
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001869 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1870 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001871 }
1872 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001873}
1874
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001875
1876/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1877/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1878/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1879Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1880 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001881 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001882 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001883
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001884 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1885 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001886 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001887 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1888 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1889 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1890 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001891 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001892 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1893
1894 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1895 // loop.
1896 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1897 return 0;
1898 }
1899
1900 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1901 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1902 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1903 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1904 if (NonConstBB) {
1905 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1906 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1907 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001908
1909 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001910 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001911 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001912 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001913 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001914
1915 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1916 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1917 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001918 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001919 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001920 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001921 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1922 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1923 else
1924 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 } else {
1926 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1927 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001928 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001929 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1930 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001931 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001932 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001933 CI->getPredicate(),
1934 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1935 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001936 else
1937 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1938
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001939 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001940 }
1941 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001942 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001943 } else {
1944 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1945 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001946 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001947 Value *InV;
1948 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001949 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001950 } else {
1951 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001952 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001953 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1954 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001955 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001956 }
1957 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001958 }
1959 }
1960 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1961}
1962
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001963
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001964/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1965/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1966/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1967/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1968bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1969 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1970 // ones.
1971
1972 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1973 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1974 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1975 // sign extend fine.
1976 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1977 return true;
1978
1979
1980 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1981 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1982 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1983 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1984
1985 // TODO: Implement.
1986
1987 return false;
1988}
1989
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001990
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001991Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001992 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001993 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001994
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001995 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001996 // X + undef -> undef
1997 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1999
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002000 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002001 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002002 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002004 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00002005 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
2006 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00002007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00002008 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002009
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002010 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002011 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002012 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002013 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002014 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002015 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002016
2017 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2018 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002019 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2020 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2021 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2022 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2023 return &I;
2024 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002025
2026 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2027 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2028 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2029 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2030 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2031 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2032 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002033 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002034
2035 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2036 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2037 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002038
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002039 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2040 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002041 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2042 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002043 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002044 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002045
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002046 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002047 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2048 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002049 do {
2050 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002051 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2052 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002053 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2054 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002055 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002056 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2057 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002058 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002059 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002060 }
2061 }
2062 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002063 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2064 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2065 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002066
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002067 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002068 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2069 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2070 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002071 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2072 switch (Size) {
2073 default: break;
2074 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2075 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2076 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2077 }
2078 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002079 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002080 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002081 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002082 }
2083 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002084 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002085
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002086 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2087 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2088
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002089 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002090 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002091 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002092
2093 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2094 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2095 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2096 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2097 }
2098 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2099 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2100 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2101 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2102 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002103 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002104
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002105 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002106 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2107 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002108 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2109 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002111 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002112 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002113 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002114 }
2115
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002116 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002117 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002118
2119 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002120 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2121 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002122 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002123
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002124
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002125 ConstantInt *C2;
2126 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2127 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002128 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002129
2130 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2131 ConstantInt *C1;
2132 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002133 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002134 }
2135
2136 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002137 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002138 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002139
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002140 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002141 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2142 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002143
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002144
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002145 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002146 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002147 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2148 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002149
2150 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2151 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2152 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2153 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2154 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2155 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2156 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2157 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2158 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2159 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2160
2161 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002162 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002163 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002164 }
2165 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002166
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002168 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002169 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2170 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2171 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2172 if (W != Y) {
2173 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002174 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002175 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002176 std::swap(W, X);
2177 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002178 std::swap(Y, Z);
2179 std::swap(W, X);
2180 }
2181 }
2182
2183 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002184 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002185 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002186 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002187 }
2188 }
2189 }
2190
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002191 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002192 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002193 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002194 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002195
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002196 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2197 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002198 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002199 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2200 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2201 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002202 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002203
2204 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002205 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002206
2207 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002208 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002209
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002210 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2211 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002212 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002213 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002214 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002215 }
2216 }
2217 }
2218
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002219 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2220 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002221 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002222 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002223 }
2224
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002225 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002226 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002227 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002228 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2229 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002230 if (!CI) {
2231 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2232 Other = LHS;
2233 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002234 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002235 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2236 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002237 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002238 unsigned AS =
2239 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002240 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2241 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002242 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002243 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002244 }
2245 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002246
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002247 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002248 {
2249 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002250 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002251 if (!SI) {
2252 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002253 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002254 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002255 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002256 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2257 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002258 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002259
2260 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2261 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002262 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2263 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002264 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002265 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2266 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002267 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002268 }
2269 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002270
2271 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2272 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2273 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002275
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002276 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2277 // integer add followed by a sext.
2278 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2279 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2280 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2281 Constant *CI =
2282 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2283 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2284 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2285 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2286 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2287 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2288 CI, "addconv");
2289 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2290 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2291 }
2292 }
2293
2294 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2295 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2296 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2297 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2298 // integer add will not overflow.
2299 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2300 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2301 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2302 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2303 // Insert the new integer add.
2304 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2305 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2306 "addconv");
2307 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2308 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2309 }
2310 }
2311 }
2312
2313 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2314 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2315 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2316 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2317 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2318 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2319 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2320 // instcombined.
2321 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2322 Constant *CI =
2323 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2324 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2325 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2326 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2327 // Insert the new integer add.
2328 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2329 CI, "addconv");
2330 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2331 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2332 }
2333 }
2334
2335 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2336 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2337 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2338 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2339 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2340 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2341 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2342 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2343 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2344 // Insert the new integer add.
2345 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2346 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2347 "addconv");
2348 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2349 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2350 }
2351 }
2352 }
2353
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002354 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002355}
2356
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002357Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002358 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002359
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002360 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2361 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002363
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002364 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002365 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002366 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002367
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002368 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2370 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2372
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002373 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2374 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002375 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002376 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002377
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002378 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002379 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002380 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002381 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002382
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002383 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2384 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002385 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002386 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002387 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002388 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002389 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002390 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002391 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002392 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002393 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002394 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002395 }
2396 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002397 }
2398 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2399 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2400 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002401 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002402 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002403 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002404 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002405 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002406 }
2407 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002408 }
2409 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002410 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002411
2412 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2413 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002414 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002415 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002416
2417 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2418 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2419 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002420 }
2421
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002422 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2423 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2424
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002425 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2426 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002427 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002428 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002429 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002430 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002431 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002432 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2433 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2434 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002435 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002436 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2437 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002438 }
2439
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002440 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002441 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2442 // is not used by anyone else...
2443 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002444 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002445 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2447 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2448 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2449 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002450
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002451 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002452 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002453 }
2454
2455 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2456 //
2457 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2458 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2459 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2460
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002461 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002462 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2463 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002464 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002465
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002466 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002467 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002468 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002469 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002470 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002472 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2473
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002474 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002475 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002476 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002477 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002478 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002479 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002480
2481 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2482 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2483 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2484 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2485 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2486 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002487 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002488 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002489 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002490 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002491 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002492 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002493
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002494 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002495 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002496 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002497 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2499 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002501 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2502 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002503 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002504 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002505 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002506
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002507 ConstantInt *C1;
2508 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002509 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002510 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002511
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002512 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2513 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002514 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002515 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002516 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002517}
2518
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002519/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2520/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2521/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2522/// signed.
2523static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2524 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002525 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2527 TrueIfSigned = true;
2528 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002529 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2530 TrueIfSigned = true;
2531 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002532 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2533 TrueIfSigned = false;
2534 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002535 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2536 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2537 TrueIfSigned = true;
2538 return RHS->getValue() ==
2539 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2540 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2541 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2542 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002543 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002544 default:
2545 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002546 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002547}
2548
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002549Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002550 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002551 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002552
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002553 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2555
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002556 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002557 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2558 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002559
2560 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002561 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002562 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2563 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002564 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002565 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002566
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002567 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2569 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2571 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002572 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002573
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002574 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002575 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002576 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002577 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002578 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002579 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002580 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002582
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002583 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2584 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002585 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2587 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2588 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2590
2591 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2592 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2593 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2594 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2595 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002596 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002597
2598 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2599 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002600 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002601 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002602 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002603 Op1, "tmp");
2604 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2605 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2606 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002607 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002608
2609 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002610
2611 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2612 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002613 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002614 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002615
2616 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2617 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2618 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002619 }
2620
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002621 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2622 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002623 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002624
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002625 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2626 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2627
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002628 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2629 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2630 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2631 // formed.
2632 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002633 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002634 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002635 BoolCast = CI;
2636 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002637 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002638 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002639 BoolCast = CI;
2640 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002641 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002642 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2643 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002644 bool TIS = false;
2645
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002646 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002647 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2648 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002649 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2650 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002651 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002652 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002653 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002654 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002655 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002656 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002657 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2658 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002659
2660 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2661 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002662 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002663 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2664 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002665 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2666 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2667 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2668 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2669 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002670
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002671 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002672 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002673 }
2674 }
2675 }
2676
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002677 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002678}
2679
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002680/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2681/// instruction.
2682bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2683 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2684
2685 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2686 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2687 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2688 if (ST->isNullValue())
2689 NonNullOperand = 2;
2690 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2691 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2692 if (ST->isNullValue())
2693 NonNullOperand = 1;
2694
2695 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2696 return false;
2697
2698 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2699
2700 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2701 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2702
2703 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2704 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2705 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2706 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2707 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2708
2709 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2710 // early exit.
2711 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2712 return true;
2713
2714 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2715 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2716
2717 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2718 --BBI;
2719 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2720 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2721 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2722 break;
2723
2724 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2725 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2726 I != E; ++I) {
2727 if (*I == SI) {
2728 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2729 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2730 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2731 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2732 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2733 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2734 }
2735 }
2736
2737 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2738 if (&*BBI == SI)
2739 SI = 0;
2740 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2741 SelectCond = 0;
2742
2743 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2744 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2745 break;
2746
2747 }
2748 return true;
2749}
2750
2751
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002752/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2753/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2754/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2755/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002756Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002757 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002758
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002759 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2760 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2761 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2762 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002764 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002765 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002766
2767 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002768 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002770
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002771 return 0;
2772}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002773
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002774/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2775/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2776/// division instructions.
2777/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002778Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002779 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2780
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002781 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002782 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2783 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2784 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2785 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2787 }
2788
2789 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2791 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002792
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002793 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2794 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002795
2796 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2797 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2798 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2799 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002800
2801 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2802 // div X, 1 == X
2803 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2805
2806 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2807 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2808 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2809 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002810 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2812 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002813 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002814 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002815 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002816
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002817 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002818 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2819 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2820 return R;
2821 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2822 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2823 return NV;
2824 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002825 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002826
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002827 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002828 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002829 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2831
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002832 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2833 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2835
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002836 return 0;
2837}
2838
2839Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2840 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2841
2842 // Handle the integer div common cases
2843 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2844 return Common;
2845
2846 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2847 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2848 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2849 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002850 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002851 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002852 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002853 }
2854
2855 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002856 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002857 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2858 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002859 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002860 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002861 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002862 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002863 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002864 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002866 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002867 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002868 }
2869 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002870 }
2871
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002872 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2873 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002874 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002875 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002876 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002877 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002878 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002879 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002880 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002881 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2882 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002883 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002884 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2885 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2886
2887 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2888 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002889 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002890 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2891 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002892
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002893 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002894 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002895 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002896 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002897 return 0;
2898}
2899
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002900Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2901 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2902
2903 // Handle the integer div common cases
2904 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2905 return Common;
2906
2907 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2908 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2909 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002910 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002911
2912 // -X/C -> X/-C
2913 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002914 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002915 }
2916
2917 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2918 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002919 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002920 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002921 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002922 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002923 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002924 }
2925 }
2926
2927 return 0;
2928}
2929
2930Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2931 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2932}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002933
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002934/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2935/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2936/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2937/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2938Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002939 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002940
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002941 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002942 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2943 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2945
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002946 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2947 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002949 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002950 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002951 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2952 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002953
2954 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002955 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2956 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002957
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002958 return 0;
2959}
2960
2961/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2962/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2963/// remainder instructions.
2964/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2965Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2966 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2967
2968 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2969 return common;
2970
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002971 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002972 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2973 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2975
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002976 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2978
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002979 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2980 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2981 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2982 return R;
2983 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2984 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2985 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002986 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002987
2988 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2989 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2990 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2991 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2992 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2993 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002994 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002995 }
2996
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002997 return 0;
2998}
2999
3000Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3001 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3002
3003 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3004 return common;
3005
3006 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3007 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3008 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3009 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3010 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003011 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003012 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003013 }
3014
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003015 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003016 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3017 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3018 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003019 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003020 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003022 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003023 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003024 }
3025 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003026 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003027
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003028 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3029 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3030 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3031 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3032 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3033 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003034 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3035 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003036 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003037 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003038 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003039 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003040 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003041 }
3042 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003043 }
3044
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003045 return 0;
3046}
3047
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003048Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3049 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3050
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003051 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003052 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3053 return common;
3054
3055 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003056 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3057 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3058 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003059 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3060 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3061 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3062 return &I;
3063 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003064
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003065 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003066 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003067 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3068 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3069 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3070 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003071 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003072 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003073 }
3074
3075 return 0;
3076}
3077
3078Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003079 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3080}
3081
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003082// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3083// constant.
3084static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003085 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003086}
3087
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003088// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3089// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3090static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003091 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003092}
3093
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003094/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003095/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3096///
3097/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3098///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003099/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3100/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003101///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003102/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3103/// 0 A > B
3104/// 1 A == B
3105/// 2 A < B
3106///
3107/// <=> Value Definition
3108/// 000 0 Always false
3109/// 001 1 A > B
3110/// 010 2 A == B
3111/// 011 3 A >= B
3112/// 100 4 A < B
3113/// 101 5 A != B
3114/// 110 6 A <= B
3115/// 111 7 Always true
3116///
3117static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3118 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003119 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003120 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3121 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3122 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3124 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3125 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3126 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3127 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3128 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3129 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003130 // True -> 7
3131 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003132 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003133 return 0;
3134 }
3135}
3136
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003137/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3138/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3139/// predicate by reference.
3140static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3141 isOrdered = false;
3142 switch (CC) {
3143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003145 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3146 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3151 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3152 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003153 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3154 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003155 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3156 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003157 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003158 default:
3159 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3160 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3161 return 0;
3162 }
3163}
3164
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003165/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3166/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003167/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003168/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003169static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3170 switch (code) {
3171 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003172 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003173 case 1:
3174 if (sign)
3175 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3176 else
3177 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3178 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3179 case 3:
3180 if (sign)
3181 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3182 else
3183 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3184 case 4:
3185 if (sign)
3186 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3187 else
3188 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3189 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3190 case 6:
3191 if (sign)
3192 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3193 else
3194 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003195 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003196 }
3197}
3198
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003199/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3200/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3201/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3202static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3203 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3204 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003205 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003206 case 0:
3207 if (isordered)
3208 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3209 else
3210 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3211 case 1:
3212 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003213 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3214 else
3215 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003216 case 2:
3217 if (isordered)
3218 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3219 else
3220 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003221 case 3:
3222 if (isordered)
3223 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3224 else
3225 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3226 case 4:
3227 if (isordered)
3228 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3229 else
3230 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3231 case 5:
3232 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003233 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3234 else
3235 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3236 case 6:
3237 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003238 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3239 else
3240 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003241 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003242 }
3243}
3244
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003245/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3246/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003247static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3248 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003249 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3250 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003251}
3252
3253namespace {
3254// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3255struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003256 InstCombiner &IC;
3257 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003258 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3259 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3260 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3261 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003262 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003263 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3264 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003265 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3266 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003267 return false;
3268 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003269 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3270 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3271 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3272 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3273 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003274 }
3275
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003276 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003277 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003278 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003279 unsigned Code;
3280 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3281 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3282 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3283 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003284 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003285 }
3286
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003287 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3288 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3289
3290 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003291 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3292 return I;
3293 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3294 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3295 }
3296};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003297} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003298
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003299// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3300// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003301// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003302Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003303 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3304 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003305 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3306 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003307 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003308 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003309 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003310
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003311 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3312 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003313 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003314 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003315 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003316 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003317 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003318 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003319 }
3320 break;
3321 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003322 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003324
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003325 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3326 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003327 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003328 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003329 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003330 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003331 }
3332 break;
3333 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003334 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003335 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3336 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3337 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003338 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003339
3340 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003341 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003342 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3343 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3344 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003345 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003346
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003347 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3348 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3349 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3350 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3351 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3352 // no effect.
3353 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3354 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3355 return &TheAnd;
3356 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003357 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003358 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003359 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003360 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003361 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003362 }
3363 }
3364 }
3365 }
3366 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003367
3368 case Instruction::Shl: {
3369 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3370 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3371 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003372 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003373 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003374 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3375 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003376
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003377 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3378 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3380 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003381 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3382 return &TheAnd;
3383 }
3384 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003385 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003386 case Instruction::LShr:
3387 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003388 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3389 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3390 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3391 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003392 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003393 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003394 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3395 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003396
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003397 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3398 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3400 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3401 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3402 return &TheAnd;
3403 }
3404 break;
3405 }
3406 case Instruction::AShr:
3407 // Signed shr.
3408 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3409 // with an and.
3410 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003411 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003412 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003413 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3414 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003415 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003416 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003417 // Make the argument unsigned.
3418 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003419 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003420 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003421 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003422 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003423 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003424 }
3425 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003426 }
3427 return 0;
3428}
3429
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003430
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003431/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3432/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003433/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3434/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003435/// insert new instructions.
3436Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003437 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3438 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003439 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003440 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003441 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003442
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003443 if (Inside) {
3444 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003445 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003447 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003448 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003449 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003450 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3451 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3452 }
3453
3454 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3455 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003456 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003457 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003458 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3459 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003460 }
3461
3462 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003463 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003464
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003465 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003466 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003467 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003468 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3469 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3470 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3471 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003472
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003473 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3474 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3475 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003476 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003477 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003478 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3479 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003480}
3481
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003482// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3483// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3484// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3485// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003486static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003487 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003488 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3489 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003490
3491 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003492 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003493 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003494 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003495 return true;
3496}
3497
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003498/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3499/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3500/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003501///
3502/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3503/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3504/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3505///
3506/// return (A +/- B).
3507///
3508Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003509 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003510 Instruction &I) {
3511 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3512 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3513 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3514
3515 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3516
3517 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3518 default: return 0;
3519 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003520 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003521 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003522 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3523 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3524 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003525 break;
3526
3527 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3528 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3529 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003530 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003531 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003532 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003533 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003534 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003535 break;
3536 }
3537 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003538 return 0;
3539 case Instruction::Or:
3540 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003541 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003542 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3543 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003544 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003545 break;
3546 return 0;
3547 }
3548
3549 Instruction *New;
3550 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003551 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003552 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003553 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003554 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3555}
3556
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003557/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3558Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3559 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003560 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003561 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3562 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3563
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003564 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003565 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003566 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003567 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003568
3569 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3570 // where C is a power of 2
3571 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3572 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3573 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Val, Val2);
3574 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3575 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
3576 }
3577
3578 // From here on, we only handle:
3579 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3580 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3581
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003582 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3583 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3584 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3585 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3586 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3587 return 0;
3588
3589 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3590 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3591 return 0;
3592
3593 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003594 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003595 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3596 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3597 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003598 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003599 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003600 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3601
3602 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003603 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3604 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3605 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3606 }
3607
3608 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3609 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3610 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3611 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3612 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3613 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3614 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3615
3616 switch (LHSCC) {
3617 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3618 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3619 switch (RHSCC) {
3620 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3621 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3623 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3626 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3628 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3629 }
3630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3631 switch (RHSCC) {
3632 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3634 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3635 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
3636 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3638 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3639 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
3640 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3641 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3642 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3646 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3647 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3648 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3649 Val->getName()+".off");
3650 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
3651 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3652 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
3653 }
3654 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3655 }
3656 break;
3657 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3658 switch (RHSCC) {
3659 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3660 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
3662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3664 break;
3665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3666 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3669 break;
3670 }
3671 break;
3672 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3673 switch (RHSCC) {
3674 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3675 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3676 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
3677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3678 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3679 break;
3680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3681 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3682 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3683 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3684 break;
3685 }
3686 break;
3687 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3688 switch (RHSCC) {
3689 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3690 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3693 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3694 break;
3695 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3696 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3697 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3698 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003699 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003700 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false, true, I);
3701 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3702 break;
3703 }
3704 break;
3705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3706 switch (RHSCC) {
3707 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3710 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3711 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3712 break;
3713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3714 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3715 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3716 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003717 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003718 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true, true, I);
3719 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3720 break;
3721 }
3722 break;
3723 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003724
3725 return 0;
3726}
3727
3728
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003729Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003730 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003731 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003732
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003733 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3735
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003736 // and X, X = X
3737 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003738 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003739
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003740 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003741 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003742 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003743 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3744 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3745 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003746 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003747 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003748 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003749 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003750 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003752 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003754 }
3755 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003756
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003757 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003758 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3759 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003760
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003761 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003762 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003763 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003764 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3765 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3766 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3767 case Instruction::Xor:
3768 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003769 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3770 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3771 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3772 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003773 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003774 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3775 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003776 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003777 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003778 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003779 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003780 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3781 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003782 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003783 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3784 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003785 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003786 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3787 }
3788 }
3789
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003790 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003791 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003792 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3793 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3794 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3795 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003796 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003797 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003798 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003799 break;
3800
3801 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003802 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3803 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3804 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3805 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003806 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003807
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003808 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3809 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3810 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3811 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3812 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3813 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3814
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003815 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003816 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3817 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003818 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3819 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3820 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3821 }
3822 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003823 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003824
3825 case Instruction::Shl:
3826 case Instruction::LShr:
3827 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3828 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003829 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003830 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3831 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3832 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3833 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3834 }
3835 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003836 }
3837
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003838 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003839 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003840 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003841 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003842 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3843 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3844 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3845 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003846 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003847 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003848 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003849 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3850 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003851 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3852 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3853 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003854 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003855 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3856 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003857 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003858 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003859 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003860 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003861 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003862 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3863 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3864 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003865 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003866 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3868 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003869 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003870 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003871 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003872
3873 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3874 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003875 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003876 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003877 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3878 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3879 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003880 }
3881
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003882 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3883 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003884
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003885 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3886 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3887
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003888 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003889 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003890 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003891 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003892 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003893 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003894 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003895
3896 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003897 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3898 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003899 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003901
3902 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3903 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3904 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003905 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003906 }
3907 }
3908
3909 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003910 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003912
3913 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3914 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3915 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003916 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003917 }
3918 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003919
3920 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3921 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3922 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3923 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3924 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3925 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3926 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3927 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3928 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3929 }
3930 }
3931 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3932 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3933 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3934 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3935 std::swap(A, B);
3936 }
3937 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003938 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003939 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003940 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003941 }
3942 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003943 }
3944
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003945 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3946 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3947 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003948 return R;
3949
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003950 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
3951 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
3952 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003953 }
3954
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003955 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003956 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3957 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3958 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3959 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003960 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003961 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003962 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3963 I.getType(), TD) &&
3964 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3965 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003966 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003967 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3968 I.getName());
3969 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003970 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003971 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003972 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003973
3974 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003975 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3976 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3977 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003978 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3979 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3980 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003981 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003982 SI1->getOperand(0),
3983 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003984 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003985 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003986 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003987 }
3988
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003989 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003990 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3991 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3992 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003993 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3994 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003995 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3996 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3997 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3998 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003999 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4001 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
4002 RHS->getOperand(0));
4003 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004004 } else {
4005 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4006 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4007 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4008 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00004009 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4010 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4011 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4012 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4013 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004014 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4015 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4016 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4017 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4018 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4019 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4021 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4022 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4023 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4025 bool Op0Ordered;
4026 bool Op1Ordered;
4027 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4028 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4029 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4030 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4031 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4032 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4033 }
4034 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4035 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4036 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4037 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4039 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4040 // uno && ord -> false
4041 if (!Op0Ordered)
4042 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4043 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4044 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4045 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4046 }
4047 }
4048 }
4049 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004050 }
4051 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004052
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004053 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004054}
4055
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004056/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4057/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4058/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4059/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4060/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4061/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4062/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4063/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4064/// match.
4065///
4066/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4067/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4068/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4069/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4070/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4071/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4072///
4073/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4074/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4075/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4076/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4077/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4078///
4079static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4080 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4081 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4082 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4083 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4084 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4085 ByteValues) ||
4086 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4087 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004088 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004089
4090 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4091 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4092 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4093 unsigned ShAmt =
4094 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4095 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4096 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4097 return true;
4098
4099 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4100 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4101 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4102 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4103 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4104 } else {
4105 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4106 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4107 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004108 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004109 }
4110
4111 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4112 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4113
4114 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4115 ByteValues);
4116 }
4117
4118 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4119 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4120 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4121 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4122 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4123 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4124 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4125 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4126
4127 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4128 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4129 // the and mask is.
4130 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4131 continue;
4132
4133 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4134 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4135 if (MaskB == 0) {
4136 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4137 continue;
4138 }
4139
4140 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4141 if (MaskB != Byte)
4142 return true;
4143
4144 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4145 }
4146
4147 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4148 ByteValues);
4149 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004150 }
4151
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004152 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4153 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4154 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4155 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4156 // their ultimate destination.
4157 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4158 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004159
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004160 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4161 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4162 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4163 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4164 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4165 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4166 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4167 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4168 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4169 return true;
4170 } else {
4171 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4172 return true;
4173 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004174
4175 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4176 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004177 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004178 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004179 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004180 return false;
4181}
4182
4183/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4184/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4185Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004186 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004187 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4188 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4189 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004190 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004191
4192 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4193 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004194 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004195 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004196
4197 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004198 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4199 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004200 return 0;
4201
4202 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4203 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4204 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4205
4206 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4207 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4208 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4209 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004210 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004211 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004212 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004213 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004214}
4215
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004216/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4217/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4218/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4219static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
4220 Value *C, Value *D) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004221 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004222 Value *Cond = 0;
Chris Lattner321e6a62008-11-16 04:33:38 +00004223 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst(m_Value(Cond), -1, 0)))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004224 return 0;
4225
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004226 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004227 if (match(D, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004228 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004229 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004230 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4231 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004232 if (match(B, m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), 0, -1)))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004233 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004234 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst(m_Specific(Cond), -1, 0))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004235 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004236 return 0;
4237}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004238
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004239/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4240Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4241 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4242 Value *Val, *Val2;
4243 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4244 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4245
4246 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
4247 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
4248 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4249 return 0;
4250
4251 // From here on, we only handle:
4252 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4253 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4254
4255 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4256 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4257 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4258 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4259 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4260 return 0;
4261
4262 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4263 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4264 return 0;
4265
4266 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4267 bool ShouldSwap;
4268 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4269 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4270 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4271 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4272 else
4273 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4274
4275 if (ShouldSwap) {
4276 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4277 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4278 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4279 }
4280
4281 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4282 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4283 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4284 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4285 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4286 // equal.
4287 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4288
4289 switch (LHSCC) {
4290 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4291 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4292 switch (RHSCC) {
4293 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4294 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4295 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) { // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4296 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4297 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4298 Val->getName()+".off");
4299 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
4300 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
4301 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
4302 }
4303 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4304 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4306 break;
4307 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4309 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4311 }
4312 break;
4313 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4314 switch (RHSCC) {
4315 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4316 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4317 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4318 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4320 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4321 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4322 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4324 }
4325 break;
4326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4327 switch (RHSCC) {
4328 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4329 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4330 break;
4331 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4332 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4333 // this can cause overflow.
4334 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4335 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4336 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false, false, I);
4337 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4338 break;
4339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4340 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4341 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4342 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4343 break;
4344 }
4345 break;
4346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4347 switch (RHSCC) {
4348 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4350 break;
4351 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4352 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4353 // this can cause overflow.
4354 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4356 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true, false, I);
4357 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4358 break;
4359 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4360 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4362 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4363 break;
4364 }
4365 break;
4366 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4367 switch (RHSCC) {
4368 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4369 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4370 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4372 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4373 break;
4374 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4375 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4377 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4378 break;
4379 }
4380 break;
4381 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4382 switch (RHSCC) {
4383 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4384 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4385 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4386 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4387 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4388 break;
4389 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4390 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4391 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4392 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4393 break;
4394 }
4395 break;
4396 }
4397 return 0;
4398}
4399
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004400Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004401 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004402 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004403
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004404 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004405 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004406
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004407 // or X, X = X
4408 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004409 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004410
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004411 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4412 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004413 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4414 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4415 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4416 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4417 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4418 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004419 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4420 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4421 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4422 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4423 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004424 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004425
4426
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004427
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004428 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004429 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004430 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004431 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4432 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004433 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004434 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004435 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004436 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004437 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004438 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004439
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004440 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4441 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004442 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004443 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004444 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004445 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004446 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004447 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004448
4449 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4450 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004451 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004452 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004453 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4454 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4455 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004456 }
4457
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004458 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4459 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004460
4461 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4462 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4464 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4465 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4467
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004468 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4469 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004470 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004471 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4472 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4473 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004474 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4475 return BSwap;
4476 }
4477
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004478 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4479 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004480 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004481 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004482 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4483 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004484 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004485 }
4486
4487 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4488 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004489 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004490 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004491 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4492 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004493 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004494 }
4495
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004496 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004497 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004498 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4499 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004500 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4501 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4502 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4503 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4504 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4505 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4506 // replace with V+N.
4507 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4508 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4509 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4510 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4511 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4512 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4513 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4514 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4515 }
4516 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4517 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4518 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4519 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4520 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4521 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4522 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4524 }
4525 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004526 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004527 }
4528
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004529 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4530 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004531 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4532 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4533 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4534 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4535 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4536 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4537 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4538 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4539 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4540
4541 if (V1) {
4542 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004543 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4544 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004545 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004546 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004547
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004548 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004549 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
4550 return Match;
4551 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
4552 return Match;
4553 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
4554 return Match;
4555 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
4556 return Match;
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004557 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004558
4559 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004560 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4561 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4562 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004563 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4564 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4565 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004566 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004567 SI1->getOperand(0),
4568 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004569 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004570 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004571 }
4572 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004573
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004574 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4575 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004577 } else {
4578 A = 0;
4579 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004580 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004581 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4582 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004584
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004585 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004586 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004587 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004588 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004589 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004590 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004591 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004592
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004593 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4594 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4595 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004596 return R;
4597
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004598 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4599 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4600 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004601 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004602
4603 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004604 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004605 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004606 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004607 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4608 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4609 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4610 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4611 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4612 // generated.
4613 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4614 I.getType(), TD) &&
4615 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4616 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004617 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004618 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4619 I.getName());
4620 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004621 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004622 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004623 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004624 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004625 }
4626
4627
4628 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4629 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4630 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4631 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004632 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004633 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004634 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4635 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4636 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4637 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004638 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4640
4641 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4642 // rest.
4643 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4644 RHS->getOperand(0));
4645 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004646 } else {
4647 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4648 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4649 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4650 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4651 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4652 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4653 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4654 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4655 }
4656 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4657 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4658 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4659 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4660 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4661 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4663 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4665 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4667 bool Op0Ordered;
4668 bool Op1Ordered;
4669 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4670 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4671 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4672 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4673 // or'ed predicates.
4674 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4675 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4676 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4677 return I;
4678 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4680 }
4681 }
4682 }
4683 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004684 }
4685 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004686
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004687 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004688}
4689
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004690namespace {
4691
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004692// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4693struct XorSelf {
4694 Value *RHS;
4695 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4696 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4697 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4698 return &Xor;
4699 }
4700};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004701
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004702}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004703
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004704Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004705 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004706 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004707
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004708 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4709 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4710 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4711 // idiom (misuse).
4712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004714 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004715
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004716 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4717 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004718 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004720 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004721
4722 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4723 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004724 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4725 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4726 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4727 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4728 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4729 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004730 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4731 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004732 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004733
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004734 // Is this a ~ operation?
4735 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4736 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4737 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4738 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4739 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4740 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4741 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4742 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4743 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004744 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004745 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4746 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4747 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004748 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004749 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004750 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004751 }
4752 }
4753 }
4754 }
4755
4756
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004757 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004758 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4759 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4760 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004761 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4762 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004763
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004764 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4765 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4766 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4767 }
4768
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004769 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4770 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4771 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4772 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4773 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4774 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4775 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4776 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4777 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4778 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4779 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4780 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4781 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4782 }
4783 }
4784 }
4785 }
4786 }
4787
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004788 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004789 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004790 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4791 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004792 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4793 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004794 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004795 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004796 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004797
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004798 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004799 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004800 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004801 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004802 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004803 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004804 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004805 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004806 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004807 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004808 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4809 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004810 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004811
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004812 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004813 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4814 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004815 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004816 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4817 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4818 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004819 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004820 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4821 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004822 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004823 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4824 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4825 return &I;
4826 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004827 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004828 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004829 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004830
4831 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4832 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004833 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004834 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004835 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4836 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4837 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004838 }
4839
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004840 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004841 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004843
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004844 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004845 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004847
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004848
4849 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4850 if (Op1I) {
4851 Value *A, *B;
4852 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4853 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004854 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004855 I.swapOperands();
4856 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004857 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004858 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004859 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004860 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004861 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4862 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4864 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4866 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004867 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004868 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004869 std::swap(A, B);
4870 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004871 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004872 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4873 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4874 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004875 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004876 }
4877
4878 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4879 if (Op0I) {
4880 Value *A, *B;
4881 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4882 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4883 std::swap(A, B);
4884 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4885 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004886 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4887 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004888 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004889 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4890 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4892 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4893 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4894 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4895 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4896 std::swap(A, B);
4897 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004898 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004899 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004900 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4901 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004902 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004903 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004904 }
4905
4906 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4907 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4908 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4909 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4910 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4911 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004912 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004913 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4914 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004915 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004916 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4917 }
4918
4919 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4920 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4921 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4922 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4923 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4924 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004925 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004926 }
4927 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4928 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4929 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4930 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004931 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004932 }
4933
4934 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4935 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4936 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4937 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4938 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4939 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4940 if (A == C)
4941 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4942 else if (A == D)
4943 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4944 else if (B == C)
4945 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4946 else if (B == D)
4947 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4948
4949 if (X) {
4950 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004951 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4952 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004953 }
4954 }
4955 }
4956
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004957 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4958 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4959 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004960 return R;
4961
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004962 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004963 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004964 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004965 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4966 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004967 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004968 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004969 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4970 I.getType(), TD) &&
4971 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4972 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004973 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004974 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4975 I.getName());
4976 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004977 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004978 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004979 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004980 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004981
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004982 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004983}
4984
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004985/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4986/// overflowed for this type.
4987static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004988 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004989 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004990
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004991 if (IsSigned)
4992 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4993 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4994 else
4995 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4996 else
4997 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004998}
4999
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005000/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5001/// overflowed for this type.
5002static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
5003 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00005004 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005005
5006 if (IsSigned)
5007 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5008 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5009 else
5010 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5011 else
5012 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5013}
5014
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005015/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5016/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5017/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5018static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
5019 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5020 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005021 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5022 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005023
5024 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005025 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005026 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005027
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005028 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5029 ++i, ++GTI) {
5030 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00005031 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005032 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5033 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5034
5035 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5036 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5037 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5038
5039 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5040 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005041 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005042 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005043 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005044 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5045 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5046 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005047 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005048
5049 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5050 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5051 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5052 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5053 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5054 else {
5055 // Emit an add instruction.
5056 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005057 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005058 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005059 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005060 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005061 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005062 // Convert to correct type.
5063 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5064 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5065 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5066 else
5067 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5068 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5069 }
5070 if (Size != 1) {
5071 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5072 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5073 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5074 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005075 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005076 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5077 }
5078
5079 // Emit an add instruction.
5080 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5081 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5082 cast<Constant>(Result));
5083 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005084 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005085 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005086 }
5087 return Result;
5088}
5089
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005090
5091/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5092/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5093/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5094/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5095/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5096/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5097/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5098///
5099/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5100///
5101static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5102 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005103 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5104 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5105
5106 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5107 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5108 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5109 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5110 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5111 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5112 int64_t Offset = 0;
5113 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5114 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5115 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5116 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5117
5118 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5119 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5120 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5121 } else {
5122 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5123 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5124 }
5125 } else {
5126 // Found our variable index.
5127 break;
5128 }
5129 }
5130
5131 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5132 // evaluate it the general way.
5133 if (i == e) return 0;
5134
5135 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5136 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5137 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5138 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5139
5140 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5141 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5142 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5143 if (!CI) return 0;
5144
5145 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5146 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5147
5148 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5149 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5150 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5151 } else {
5152 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5153 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5154 }
5155 }
5156
5157 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5158 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5159 // the index.
5160 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5161 if (Offset == 0) {
5162 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5163 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5164 // computation crosses zero.
5165 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5166 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5167 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5168 return VariableIdx;
5169 }
5170
5171 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5172 // the pointer size, so get it.
5173 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5174
5175 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5176 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5177
5178 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5179 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5180 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5181 // multiple of the variable scale.
5182 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5183 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5184 return 0;
5185
5186 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5187 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5188 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005189 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005190 true /*SExt*/,
5191 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5192 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005193 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005194}
5195
5196
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005197/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005198/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005199Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5200 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5201 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005202 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005203
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005204 // Look through bitcasts.
5205 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5206 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005207
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005208 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5209 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005210 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005211 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5212 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5213 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5214
5215 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5216 if (Offset == 0)
5217 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005218 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5219 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005220 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005221 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5222 // compare the base pointer.
5223 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5224 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005225 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005226 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005227 if (IndicesTheSame)
5228 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5229 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5230 IndicesTheSame = false;
5231 break;
5232 }
5233
5234 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5235 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005236 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5237 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005238
5239 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5240 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005241 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005242 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005243
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005244 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5245 bool AllZeros = true;
5246 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5247 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5248 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5249 AllZeros = false;
5250 break;
5251 }
5252 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005253 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5254 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005255
5256 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005257 AllZeros = true;
5258 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5259 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5260 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5261 AllZeros = false;
5262 break;
5263 }
5264 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005265 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005266
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005267 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5268 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5269 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5270 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5271 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5272 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005273 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5274 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005275 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005276 NumDifferences = 2;
5277 break;
5278 } else {
5279 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5280 DiffOperand = i;
5281 }
5282 }
5283
5284 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5285 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005286 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005287 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005288
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005289 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005290 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5291 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005292 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5293 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005294 }
5295 }
5296
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005297 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005298 // the result to fold to a constant!
5299 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5300 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5301 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5302 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5303 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005304 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005305 }
5306 }
5307 return 0;
5308}
5309
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005310/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5311///
5312Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5313 Instruction *LHSI,
5314 Constant *RHSC) {
5315 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5316 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5317
5318 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5319 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005320 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005321 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5322
5323 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5324 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5325 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5326 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5327
5328 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005329 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5330 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005331 ++InputSize;
5332
5333 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5334 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5335 return 0;
5336
5337 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5338 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5339 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5340 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5341
5342 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5343 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5344 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5345 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005346 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5347 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5348 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005349 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005350 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5351 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5352 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005353 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005354 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5355 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5356 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005357 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005358 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5359 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5360 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005361 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005362 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5363 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5364 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005365 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005366 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5367 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5368 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005369 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5371 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5372 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5373 }
5374
5375 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5376
5377 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5378
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005379 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005380 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5381 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5382
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005383 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5384 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5385 // and large values.
5386 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5387 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5388 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5389 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5390 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5391 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
5392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5394 }
5395 } else {
5396 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5397 // +INF and large values.
5398 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5399 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5400 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5401 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5402 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5403 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
5404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5405 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5406 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005407 }
5408
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005409 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5410 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5411 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5412 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5413 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5414 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5415 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5416 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
5417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5418 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5419 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005420 }
5421
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005422 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5423 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5424 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5425 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005426 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5427 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5428 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005429 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5430 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5431 // at this point.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005432 switch (Pred) {
5433 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5434 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5435 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5439 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5440 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5441 if (RHS.isNegative())
5442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5443 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005444 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5445 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5446 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5447 if (RHS.isNegative())
5448 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5449 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005450 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5451 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5452 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5453 if (RHS.isNegative())
5454 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5455 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5456 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005457 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5458 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5459 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5460 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5461 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5462 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5464 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5465 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5466 if (RHS.isNegative())
5467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5468 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005469 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5470 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5471 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5472 if (RHS.isNegative())
5473 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5474 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5476 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5477 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5478 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5480 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5481 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5483 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5484 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5485 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5486 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5487 break;
5488 }
5489 }
5490
5491 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5492 // comparison.
5493 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5494}
5495
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005496Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5497 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005498 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005499
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005500 // Fold trivial predicates.
5501 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5503 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5504 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5505
5506 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5507 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5508 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5509 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5510 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5511 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5512 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5514 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5515 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5516 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5518
5519 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5520 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5521 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5522 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5523 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5524 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5525 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5526 return &I;
5527
5528 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5529 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5530 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5531 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5532 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5533 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5534 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5535 return &I;
5536 }
5537 }
5538
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005539 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005541
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005542 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5543 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005544 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5545 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5546 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5547 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005549 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5550 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5551 // True if unordered.
5552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005553 }
5554 }
5555
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005556 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5557 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5558 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005559 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5560 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5561 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5562 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5563 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5564 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005565 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005566 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5567 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5568 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5569 return NV;
5570 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005571 case Instruction::Select:
5572 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5573 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5574 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5575 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5576 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5577 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5578 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5579 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5580 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5581 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5582 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5583 I.getName()), I);
5584 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5585 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5586 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5587 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5588 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5589 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5590 I.getName()), I);
5591 }
5592 }
5593
5594 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005595 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005596 break;
5597 }
5598 }
5599
5600 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5601}
5602
5603Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5604 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5605 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5606 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5607
5608 // icmp X, X
5609 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005611 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005612
5613 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005615
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005616 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005617 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005618 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5619 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5620 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005621 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005623 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005624
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005625 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005626 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005627 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5628 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005630 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005631 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005632 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005633 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005635 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005636
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005638 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005639 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005640 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005641 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005642 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005643 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005644 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5646 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005647 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5649 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5650 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5651 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5652 }
5653 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5654 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5655 // FALL THROUGH
5656 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005657 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005658 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005659 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005660 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5662 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5663 // FALL THROUGH
5664 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5665 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5666 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5667 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5668 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005669 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005670 }
5671
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005672 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005673 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005674 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005675
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005676 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5677 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5678 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5679 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5680 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005681 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005682
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005683 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5684 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5685 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005686 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5687 default: break;
5688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5689 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5691 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5693 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5695 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5696 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5697 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5699 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5701 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5703 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5704 }
5705
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005706 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5707 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5708 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5709 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5710
5711 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005712 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005713 bool UnusedBit;
5714 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5715
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005716 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5717 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5718 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005719 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5720 return &I;
5721
5722 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005723 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5724 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5725 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005726 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5727 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5728 else
5729 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5730
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005731 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5732 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5733 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5734 if (Min == Max)
5735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5736 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5737 CI));
5738
5739 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5740 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5741 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005742 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5743 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5745 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5747 break;
5748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5749 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5751 break;
5752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005753 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005755 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005757 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5758 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5759 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5760 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5761
5762 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5763 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5764 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5765 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005766 break;
5767 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005768 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005770 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005771 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005772
5773 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5774 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5775 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5776 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5777
5778 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5779 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5780 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5781 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005782 break;
5783 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005784 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005786 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005788 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5789 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005790 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005791 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005792 break;
5793 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005794 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005796 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005798
5799 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5800 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5801 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5802 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005803 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005804 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005805 }
5806
5807 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5808 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5809 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5810 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5811 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5812 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5813 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5814 if (I.hasOneUse())
5815 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5816 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5817 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5818 return 0;
5819
5820 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5821 // can be folded into the comparison.
5822 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005823 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005824 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005825 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005826 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005827 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5828 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005829 }
5830
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005831 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005832 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5833 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5834 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005835 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5836 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005837 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005838 bool isAllZeros = true;
5839 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5840 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5841 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5842 isAllZeros = false;
5843 break;
5844 }
5845 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005846 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005847 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5848 }
5849 break;
5850
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005851 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005852 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5853 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5854 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5855 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5856 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5857 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005858 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005859 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005860 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5861 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5862 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5863 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5864 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5865 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5866 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005867 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5868 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5869 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5870 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5871 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005872 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5873 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005874 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5875 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5876 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5877 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5878 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005879 }
5880 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005881
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005882 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005883 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005884 break;
5885 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005886 case Instruction::Malloc:
5887 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5888 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5889 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5890 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005892 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005893 }
5894 break;
5895 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005896 }
5897
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005898 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005899 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005900 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005901 return NI;
5902 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005903 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5904 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005905 return NI;
5906
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005907 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005908 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5909 // now.
5910 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5911 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5912 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005913 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5914 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005915 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005916
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005917 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5918 // so eliminate it as well.
5919 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5920 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005921
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005922 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005923 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005924 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005925 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005926 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005927 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005928 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005929 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005930 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005931 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005932 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005933 }
5934
5935 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005936 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005937 // This comes up when you have code like
5938 // int X = A < B;
5939 // if (X) ...
5940 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005941 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5942 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005943 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005944 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005945 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005946
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005947 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5948 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5949 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005950 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5951 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5952 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005953 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005954 default: break;
5955 case Instruction::Add:
5956 case Instruction::Sub:
5957 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005958 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5959 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5960 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005961 break;
5962 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005963 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5964 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5965 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5966 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5967 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5968 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5969 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5970 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005971 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005972 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5973 Mask);
5974 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5975 Mask);
5976 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5977 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5978 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005979 }
5980 }
5981 break;
5982 }
5983 }
5984 }
5985 }
5986
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005987 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5988 { Value *A, *B;
5989 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5990 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5991 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5992 }
5993
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005994 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005995 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005996
5997 // -x == -y --> x == y
5998 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5999 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
6000 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
6001
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006002 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
6003 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6004 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
6005 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6006 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
6007 }
6008
6009 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6010 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
6011 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
6012 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
6013 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006014 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006015 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006016 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
6017 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6018 }
6019
6020 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
6021 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6022 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6023 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6024 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
6025 }
6026 }
6027
6028 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6029 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006030 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6031 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006032 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6033 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006034 }
6035 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006036 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006037 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6038 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006039 }
6040 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006041 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006042 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6043 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006044 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006045
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006046 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6047 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6048 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6049 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6050 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6051
6052 if (A == C) {
6053 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6054 } else if (A == D) {
6055 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6056 } else if (B == C) {
6057 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6058 } else if (B == D) {
6059 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6060 }
6061
6062 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006063 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6064 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006065 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6066 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6067 return &I;
6068 }
6069 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006070 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006071 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006072}
6073
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006074
6075/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6076/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6077Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6078 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6079 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6080 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6081
6082 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6083 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6084 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6085 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6086 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6087 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6088 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6089 // if it finds it.
6090 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6091 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6092 return 0;
6093 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006094 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006095 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6096 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6097 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6098 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6099 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006100
6101 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6102 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6103 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6104 // instead of computing a divide.
6105 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6106
6107 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6108 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6109 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6110 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6111 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6112
6113 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006114 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006115
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006116 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6117 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6118 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6119 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6120 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6121 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6122 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6123 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6124 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6125
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006126 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006127 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006128 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006129 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6130 if (!HiOverflow)
6131 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006132 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006133 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006134 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006135 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6136 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006137 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006138 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6139 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6140 if (!HiOverflow)
6141 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006142 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006143 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006144 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006145 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6146 if (!LoOverflow) {
6147 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6148 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6149 true) ? -1 : 0;
6150 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006151 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006152 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006153 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006154 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006155 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6156 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006157 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6158 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6159 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6160 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006161 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006162 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006163 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006164 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006165 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006166 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006167 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006168 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6169 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006170 if (!HiOverflow)
6171 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006172 }
6173
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006174 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6175 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006176 }
6177
6178 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006179 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006180 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6181 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6182 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6184 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006185 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006186 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6187 else if (LoOverflow)
6188 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6189 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6190 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006191 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006192 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6193 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6195 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006196 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006197 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6198 else if (LoOverflow)
6199 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6200 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6201 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006202 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006203 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6204 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006205 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6207 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006209 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006210 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6211 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006212 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006214 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6215 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6216 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006217 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6218 else
6219 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6220 }
6221}
6222
6223
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006224/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6225///
6226Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6227 Instruction *LHSI,
6228 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6229 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6230
6231 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006232 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006233 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6234 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6235 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006236 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6237 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006238 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6239
6240 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6241 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6242 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6243 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6244 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6245 return &ICI;
6246 }
6247
6248 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6249 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6250
6251 // If so, the new one isn't.
6252 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6253
6254 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6255 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6256 else
6257 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6258 }
6259 }
6260 break;
6261 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6262 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6263 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6264 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6265
6266 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6267 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6268 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6269 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6270 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6271 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6272 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6273 // bit would not work.
6274 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006275 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6276 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006277 uint32_t BitWidth =
6278 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6279 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6280 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6281 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6282 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6283 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006284 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006285 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6286 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6287 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6288 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6289 }
6290 }
6291
6292 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6293 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6294 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6295 // access.
6296 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6297 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6298 Shift = 0;
6299
6300 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6301 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6302 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6303 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6304
6305 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6306 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6307 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6308 if (ShAmt) {
6309 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6310 if (!CanFold) {
6311 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6312 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6313 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6314 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6315
6316 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6317 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6318 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6319 CanFold = true;
6320 }
6321
6322 if (CanFold) {
6323 Constant *NewCst;
6324 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6325 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6326 else
6327 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6328
6329 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6330 // compared.
6331 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6332 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6333 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6334 // result is always true or false now.
6335 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6337 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6339 } else {
6340 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6341 Constant *NewAndCST;
6342 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6343 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6344 else
6345 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6346 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6347 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6348 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6349 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6350 return &ICI;
6351 }
6352 }
6353 }
6354
6355 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6356 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6357 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6358 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6359 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6360 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6361 // Compute C << Y.
6362 Value *NS;
6363 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006364 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006365 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6366 } else {
6367 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006368 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006369 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6370 }
6371 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6372
6373 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6374 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006375 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006376 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6377
6378 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6379 return &ICI;
6380 }
6381 }
6382 break;
6383
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006384 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6385 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6386 if (!ShAmt) break;
6387
6388 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6389
6390 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6391 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6392 // simplified.
6393 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6394 break;
6395
6396 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6397 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6398 // comparison cannot succeed.
6399 Constant *Comp =
6400 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6401 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6402 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6403 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6405 }
6406
6407 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6408 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6409 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6410 Constant *Mask =
6411 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006412
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006413 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006414 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006415 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6416 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6417 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6418 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006419 }
6420 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006421
6422 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6423 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6424 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6425 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6426 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6427 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6428 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6429 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006430 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006431 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6432 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6433
6434 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6435 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6436 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006437 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006438 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006439
6440 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006441 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006442 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006443 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006444 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006445
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006446 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6447 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6448 // simplified.
6449 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6450 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6451 break;
6452
6453 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006454
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006455 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6456 // comparison cannot succeed.
6457 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6458 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6459 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6460 else
6461 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6462
6463 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6464 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6465 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6467 }
6468
6469 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6470 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6471 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006472 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6473 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006474 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6475 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6476 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6477 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006478
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006479 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006480 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6481 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6482 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006483
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006484 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006485 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006486 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6487 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6488 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6489 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006490 }
6491 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006492 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006493
6494 case Instruction::SDiv:
6495 case Instruction::UDiv:
6496 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6497 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6498 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6499 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6500 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6501 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006502 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6503 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6504 DivRHS))
6505 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006506 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006507
6508 case Instruction::Add:
6509 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6510
6511 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6512 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6513 if (!LHSC) break;
6514 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6515
6516 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6517 .subtract(LHSV);
6518
6519 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6520 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6521 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6522 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6523 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6524 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6525 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6526 }
6527 } else {
6528 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6529 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6530 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6531 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6532 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6533 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6534 }
6535 }
6536 }
6537 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006538 }
6539
6540 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6541 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6542 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6543
6544 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6545 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6546 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6547 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6548 case Instruction::SRem:
6549 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6550 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6551 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6552 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6553 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006554 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006555 BO->getName());
6556 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6557 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6558 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6559 }
6560 }
6561 break;
6562 case Instruction::Add:
6563 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6564 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6565 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6566 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6567 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6568 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6569 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6570 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6571 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6572
6573 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6574 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6575 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6576 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6577 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006578 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006579 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6580 Neg->takeName(BO);
6581 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6582 }
6583 }
6584 break;
6585 case Instruction::Xor:
6586 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6587 // the explicit xor.
6588 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6589 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6590 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6591
6592 // FALLTHROUGH
6593 case Instruction::Sub:
6594 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6595 if (RHSV == 0)
6596 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6597 BO->getOperand(1));
6598 break;
6599
6600 case Instruction::Or:
6601 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6602 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6603 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6604 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6605 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6606 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6607 isICMP_NE));
6608 }
6609 break;
6610
6611 case Instruction::And:
6612 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6613 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6614 // comparison can never succeed!
6615 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6617 isICMP_NE));
6618
6619 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6620 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6621 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6622 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6623 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6624
6625 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006626 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006627 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6628 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6629 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6630 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6631 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6632 }
6633
6634 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6635 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6636 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6637 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6638 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6639 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6640 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6641 }
6642 }
6643 default: break;
6644 }
6645 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6646 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6647 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6648 AddToWorkList(II);
6649 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6650 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6651 return &ICI;
6652 }
6653 }
6654 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006655 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6656 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006657 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6658 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6659 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6660 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6661 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6662 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6663 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6664 // smaller constant values.
6665 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6666 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6667 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6668 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6669 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6670 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6671 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6672 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6673 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6674 }
6675 }
6676 }
6677 }
6678 return 0;
6679}
6680
6681/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6682/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6683///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006684Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6685 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006686 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6687 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006688 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006689 Value *RHSCIOp;
6690
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006691 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6692 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6693 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6694 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6695 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6696 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6697 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006698 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006699 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6700 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6701 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6702 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006703 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006704 }
6705
6706 if (RHSOp)
6707 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6708 }
6709
6710 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6711 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006712 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6713 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006714 return 0;
6715
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006716 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6717 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006718
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006719 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006720 // Not an extension from the same type?
6721 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006722 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6723 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006724
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006725 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006726 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6727 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6728 return 0;
6729
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006730 // Deal with equality cases early.
6731 if (ICI.isEquality())
6732 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6733
6734 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6735 // signed comparison.
6736 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6737 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6738
6739 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6740 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006741 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006742
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006743 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6744 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6745 if (!CI)
6746 return 0;
6747
6748 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6749 // reextended to DestTy.
6750 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6751 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6752
6753 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6754 if (Res2 == CI) {
6755 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6756 // For example, we might have:
6757 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6758 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6759 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6760 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6761 // because %A may have negative value.
6762 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006763 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6764 // signless.
6765 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006766 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006767 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006768 }
6769
6770 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6771 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6772
6773 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6774 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6775 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006777 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006778 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006779
6780 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6781 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6782 Value *Result;
6783 if (isSignedCmp) {
6784 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006785 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006786 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006787 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006788 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006789 } else {
6790 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6791 if (isSignedExt) {
6792 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6793 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006794 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006795 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6796 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6797 } else {
6798 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006799 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006800 }
6801 }
6802
6803 // Finally, return the value computed.
6804 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006805 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006807
6808 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6809 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6810 "ICmp should be folded!");
6811 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6813 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006814}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006815
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006816Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6817 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6818}
6819
6820Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6821 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6822}
6823
6824Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006825 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6826 return R;
6827
6828 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6829
6830 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6831 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6832 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6834
6835 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006836 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6837 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006838 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006839 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006840
6841 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006842}
6843
6844Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6845 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006846 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006847
6848 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6849 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006850 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006851 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6852 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006853
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006854 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6855 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006857 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006858 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6859 }
6860 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006861 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6863 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006865 }
6866
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006867 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6868 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6869 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006870 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006871 return R;
6872
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006873 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006874 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6875 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006876 return 0;
6877}
6878
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006879Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006880 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006881 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006882
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006883 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6884 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006885 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6886 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6887 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006888 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6889 return &I;
6890
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006891 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6892 // of a signed value.
6893 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006894 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006895 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006896 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6897 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006898 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006899 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006900 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006901 }
6902
6903 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6904 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6905 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6906 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006907 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006908 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6909
6910 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6911 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6912 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6913 return R;
6914 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6915 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6916 return NV;
6917
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006918 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6919 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6920 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6921 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6922 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6923 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6924 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6925 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6926 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6927 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6928 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6929 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006930 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006931 I.getName());
6932 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6933
6934 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6935 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6936 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6937 // other xforms later if dead.
6938 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6939 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6940 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6941
6942 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6943 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6944 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6945 // mask as appropriate.
6946 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6947 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6948 else {
6949 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6950 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6951 }
6952
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006953 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006954 TI->getName());
6955 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6956
6957 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6958 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6959 }
6960 }
6961
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006962 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006963 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6964 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6965 Value *V1, *V2;
6966 ConstantInt *CC;
6967 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006968 default: break;
6969 case Instruction::Add:
6970 case Instruction::And:
6971 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006972 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006973 // These operators commute.
6974 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006975 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6976 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006977 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006978 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006979 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006980 Op0BO->getName());
6981 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006982 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006983 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006984 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006985 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006986 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006987 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006988 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006989 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006990
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006991 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006992 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006993 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006994 match(Op0BOOp1,
6995 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006996 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6997 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006998 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006999 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7000 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007001 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7002 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007003 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007004 V1->getName()+".mask");
7005 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7006
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007007 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007008 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007009 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007010
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007011 // FALL THROUGH.
7012 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007013 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007014 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7015 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007016 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007017 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007018 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7019 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007020 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007021 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007022 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007023 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007024 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007025 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007026 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007027 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007028 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007029
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007030 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007031 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7032 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7033 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007034 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007035 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7036 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007037 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007038 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7039 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007040 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7041 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007042 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007043 V1->getName()+".mask");
7044 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7045
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007046 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007047 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007048
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007049 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007050 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007051 }
7052
7053
7054 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7055 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7056 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7057 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7058 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7059
7060 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007061 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007062 case Instruction::Add:
7063 isValid = isLeftShift;
7064 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007065 case Instruction::Or:
7066 case Instruction::Xor:
7067 highBitSet = false;
7068 break;
7069 case Instruction::And:
7070 highBitSet = true;
7071 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007072 }
7073
7074 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7075 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7076 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7077 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7078 // operation.
7079 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007080 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007081 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007082
7083 if (isValid) {
7084 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7085
7086 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007087 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007088 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007089 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007090
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007091 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007092 NewRHS);
7093 }
7094 }
7095 }
7096 }
7097
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007098 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007099 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7100 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7101 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007102
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007103 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007104 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007105 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7106 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007107 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7108 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7109 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007110
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007111 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007112 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7113 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007114
7115 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7116
7117 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007118 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007119 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007120 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7121 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7122 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7123 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007124 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007125 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7126 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7127 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7128 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007129 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007130 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7131
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007132 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007133 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007134 }
7135
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007136 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7137 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7138 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7139 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7140 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007141 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007142 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007143 }
7144 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7145 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007146 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007147 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007148 }
7149 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7150 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7151 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7152 // generators.
7153 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7154 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007155 case 1 :
7156 case 8 :
7157 case 16 :
7158 case 32 :
7159 case 64 :
7160 case 128:
7161 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7162 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007163 default: break;
7164 }
7165 if (SExtType) {
7166 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7167 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7168 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7169 }
7170 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7171 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007172 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007173
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007174 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007175 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7176 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7177 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007178 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007179 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007180 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7181
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007182 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007183 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007184 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007185
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007186 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007187 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7188 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7189 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007190 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007191 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007192
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007193 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007194 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007195 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007196
7197 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7198 } else {
7199 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007200 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007201
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007202 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007203 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7204 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7205 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7206 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007207 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007208 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7209 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7210
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007211 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007212 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007213 }
7214
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007215 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007216 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7217 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7218 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007219 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007220 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7221
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007222 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007223 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007224 }
7225
7226 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007227 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007228 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007229 return 0;
7230}
7231
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007232
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007233/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7234/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7235/// X*Scale+Offset.
7236///
7237static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007238 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007239 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007240 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007241 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007242 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007243 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007244 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7245 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7246 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7247 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7248 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7249 Offset = 0;
7250 return I->getOperand(0);
7251 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7252 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7253 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7254 Offset = 0;
7255 return I->getOperand(0);
7256 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7257 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7258 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7259 unsigned SubScale;
7260 Value *SubVal =
7261 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7262 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7263 Scale = SubScale;
7264 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007265 }
7266 }
7267 }
7268
7269 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7270 Scale = 1;
7271 Offset = 0;
7272 return Val;
7273}
7274
7275
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007276/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7277/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007278Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007279 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007280 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007281
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007282 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7283 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007284
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007285 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7286 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7287 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7288 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7289 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7290
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007291 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007292 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007293 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007294 }
7295 }
7296
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007297 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7298 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7299 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7300 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007301
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007302 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7303 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007304 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7305
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007306 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7307 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7308 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7309 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7310
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007311 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7312 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007313 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007314
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007315 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7316 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007317 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7318 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007319 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7320 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7321
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007322 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7323 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007324 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7325 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007326
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007327 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7328 Value *Amt = 0;
7329 if (Scale == 1) {
7330 Amt = NumElements;
7331 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007332 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007333 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7334 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007335 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007336 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007337 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007338 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007339 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007340 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007341 }
7342
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007343 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7344 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007345 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007346 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7347 }
7348
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007349 AllocationInst *New;
7350 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007351 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007352 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007353 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007354 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007355 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007356
7357 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7358 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7359 // die soon.
7360 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7361 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007362 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7363 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7364 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007365 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7366 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7367 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7369}
7370
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007371/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007372/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7373/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7374/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7375/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7376///
7377/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7378/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007379///
7380/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7381/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7382/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7383/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7384/// efficiently truncated.
7385///
7386/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7387/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7388/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007389bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7390 unsigned CastOpc,
7391 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007392 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7393 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7394 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007395
7396 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007397 if (!I) return false;
7398
7399 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007400
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007401 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7402 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7403 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7404 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7405 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7406 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7407 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7408 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007409 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007410 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7411 return true;
7412 }
7413 }
7414
7415 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7416 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7417 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7418
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007419 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007420 case Instruction::Add:
7421 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007422 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007423 case Instruction::And:
7424 case Instruction::Or:
7425 case Instruction::Xor:
7426 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007427 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7428 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7429 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7430 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007431
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007432 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007433 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7434 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7435 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007436 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7437 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7438 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007439 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7440 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007441 }
7442 break;
7443 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007444 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7445 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7446 // already zeros.
7447 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007448 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7449 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7450 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007451 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007452 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7453 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007454 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7455 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007456 }
7457 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007458 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007459 case Instruction::ZExt:
7460 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007461 case Instruction::Trunc:
7462 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007463 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7464 // of casts in the input.
7465 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007466 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007467 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007468 case Instruction::Select: {
7469 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7470 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7471 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7472 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7473 NumCastsRemoved);
7474 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007475 case Instruction::PHI: {
7476 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7477 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7478 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7479 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7480 NumCastsRemoved))
7481 return false;
7482 return true;
7483 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007484 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007485 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7486 break;
7487 }
7488
7489 return false;
7490}
7491
7492/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7493/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7494/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007495Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007496 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007497 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007498 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007499
7500 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7501 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007502 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007503 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007504 case Instruction::Add:
7505 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007506 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007507 case Instruction::And:
7508 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007509 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007510 case Instruction::AShr:
7511 case Instruction::LShr:
7512 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007513 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007514 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007515 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007516 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007517 break;
7518 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007519 case Instruction::Trunc:
7520 case Instruction::ZExt:
7521 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007522 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007523 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7524 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007525 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7526 return I->getOperand(0);
7527
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007528 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007529 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007530 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007531 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007532 case Instruction::Select: {
7533 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7534 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7535 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7536 break;
7537 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007538 case Instruction::PHI: {
7539 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7540 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7541 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7542 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7543 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7544 }
7545 Res = NPN;
7546 break;
7547 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007548 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007549 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7550 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7551 break;
7552 }
7553
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007554 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007555 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7556}
7557
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007558/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7559Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007560 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7561
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007562 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007563 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007564 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007565 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7566 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7567 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7568 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007569 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007570 }
7571 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007572
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007573 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007574 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7575 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7576 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007577
7578 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007579 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7580 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7581 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007582
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007583 return 0;
7584}
7585
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007586/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7587Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7588 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7589
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007590 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007591 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7592 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007593 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7594 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7595 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7596 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007597 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007598 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7599 return &CI;
7600 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007601
7602 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7603 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7604 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7605 // non-type-safe code.
7606 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7607 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7608 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7609 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7610 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7611
7612 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7613 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7614 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7615 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7616 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7617 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7618
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007619 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7620 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7621 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007622 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007623 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007624 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007625 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7626 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007627
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007628 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7629 if (Offset < 0) {
7630 --FirstIdx;
7631 Offset += TySize;
7632 assert(Offset >= 0);
7633 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007634 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007635 }
7636
7637 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007638
7639 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7640 while (Offset) {
7641 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7642 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007643 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7644 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7645 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007646
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007647 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7648 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7649 } else {
7650 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7651 Offset = 0;
7652 OrigBase = 0;
7653 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007654 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7655 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007656 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007657 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7658 Offset %= EltSize;
7659 } else {
7660 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7661 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007662 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7663 } else {
7664 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7665 Offset = 0;
7666 OrigBase = 0;
7667 }
7668 }
7669 if (OrigBase) {
7670 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7671 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7672 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007673 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7674 NewIndices.begin(),
7675 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007676 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7677 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7678
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007679 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7680 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7681 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7682 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7683 }
7684 }
7685 }
7686 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007687 }
7688
7689 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7690}
7691
7692
7693
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007694/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7695/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007696/// cases.
7697/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7698Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7699 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7700 return Result;
7701
7702 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7703 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7704 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007705 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7706 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007707
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007708 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7709 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007710 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7711 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007712 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7713 return &CI;
7714
7715 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7716 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007717 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7718 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007719 return 0;
7720
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007721 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007722 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007723 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7724 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007725 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007726 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007727 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7728 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7729 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7730 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007731 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007732 bool DoXForm;
7733 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7734 default:
7735 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7736 // get here because of the check above.
7737 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7738 case Instruction::Trunc:
7739 DoXForm = true;
7740 break;
7741 case Instruction::ZExt:
7742 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7743 break;
7744 case Instruction::SExt:
7745 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7746 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007747 }
7748
7749 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007750 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7751 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007752 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7753 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7754 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7755 case Instruction::Trunc:
7756 case Instruction::BitCast:
7757 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7758 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7759 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7760 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7761 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007762 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7763 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007764 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007765 }
7766 case Instruction::SExt:
7767 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007768 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007769 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7770 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007771 }
7772 }
7773 }
7774
7775 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7776 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7777
7778 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7779 case Instruction::Add:
7780 case Instruction::Mul:
7781 case Instruction::And:
7782 case Instruction::Or:
7783 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007784 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007785 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7786 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7787 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7788 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7789 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007790 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7791 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007792 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007793 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7794 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007795 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007796 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007797 }
7798 }
7799
7800 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7801 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7802 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007803 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007804 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007805 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007806 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007807 }
7808 break;
7809 case Instruction::SDiv:
7810 case Instruction::UDiv:
7811 case Instruction::SRem:
7812 case Instruction::URem:
7813 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7814 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7815 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7816 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7817 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007818 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7819 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007820 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7821 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7822 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7823 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007824 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007825 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7826 }
7827 }
7828 break;
7829
7830 case Instruction::Shl:
7831 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7832 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7833 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7834 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7835 // in the value.
7836 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7837 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007838 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7839 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7840 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007841 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007842 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007843 }
7844 break;
7845 case Instruction::AShr:
7846 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7847 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7848 // simplifications.
7849 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7850 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007851 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007852 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7853 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007854 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007855 }
7856 }
7857 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007858 }
7859 return 0;
7860}
7861
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007862Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007863 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7864 return Result;
7865
7866 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7867 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007868 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7869 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007870
7871 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7872 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7873 default: break;
7874 case Instruction::LShr:
7875 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7876 // are already zeros.
7877 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007878 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007879
7880 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007881 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007882 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7883 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007884 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7886
7887 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7888 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007889 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7890 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7891 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007892 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007893 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007894 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7895
7896 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7897 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7898 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007899 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007900 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7901
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007902 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007903 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007904 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007905 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007906 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7907 "tmp"), CI);
7908 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007909 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007910 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007911 }
7912 break;
7913 }
7914 }
7915
7916 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007917}
7918
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007919/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7920/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7921Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7922 bool DoXform) {
7923 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7924 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7925 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7926 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7927 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7928
7929 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7930 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7931 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7932 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7933 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7934
7935 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7936 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7937 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007938 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007939 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7940 CI);
7941 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007942 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007943 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7944
7945 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7946 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007947 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007948 In->getName()+".not"),
7949 CI);
7950 }
7951
7952 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7953 }
7954
7955
7956
7957 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7958 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7959 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7960 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7961 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7962 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7963 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7964 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7965 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7966 // This only works for EQ and NE
7967 ICI->isEquality()) {
7968 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7969 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7970 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7971 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7972 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7973
7974 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7975 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7976 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7977
7978 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7979 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7980 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7981 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7982 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7983 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7984 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7985 }
7986
7987 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7988 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7989 if (ShiftAmt) {
7990 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7991 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007992 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007993 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7994 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7995 }
7996
7997 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7998 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007999 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008000 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
8001 }
8002
8003 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8005 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008006 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008007 }
8008 }
8009 }
8010
8011 return 0;
8012}
8013
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008014Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008015 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8016 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8017 return Result;
8018
8019 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8020
8021 // If this is a cast of a cast
8022 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008023 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8024 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8025 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8026 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
8027 // Get the sizes of the types involved
8028 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008029 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8030 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8031 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008032 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8033 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8034 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00008035 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00008036 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008037 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008038 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8040 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8041 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8042 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008043 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008044 }
8045 return And;
8046 }
8047 }
8048 }
8049
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008050 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8051 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008052
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008053 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8054 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8055 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8056 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8057 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8058 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8059 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8060 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8061 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8062 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8063 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008064 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008065 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008066 }
8067
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008068 return 0;
8069}
8070
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008071Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008072 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8073 return I;
8074
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008075 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8076
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008077 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8078 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8079 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8080 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8081 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008082
8083 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8084 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8085 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8086 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8087 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8088 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8089 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8090 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8091
8092 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8093 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8094 // bits, it is already ready.
8095 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8096 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8097 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8098 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8099 // bits, just sext from i32.
8100 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8101 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8102 } else {
8103 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8104 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8105 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8106 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8107 }
8108 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008109
8110 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8111 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8112 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8113 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8114 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8115 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8116 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8117 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8118 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8119 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8120 // into:
8121 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8122 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8123 Value *A = 0;
8124 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8125 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8126 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8127 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8128 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8129 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8130 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8131 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8132 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8133 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8134 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8135 CI.getName()), CI);
8136 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8137 }
8138 }
8139
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008140 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008141}
8142
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008143/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8144/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008145static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008146 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008147 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008148 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8149 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008150 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008151 return 0;
8152}
8153
8154/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8155/// through it until we get the source value.
8156static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8157 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8158 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8159 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8160
8161 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8162 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8163 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8164 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8165 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8166 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8167 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008168 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008169 return V;
8170 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8171 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008172 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008173 return V;
8174 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8175 }
8176
8177 return V;
8178}
8179
8180Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8181 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8182 return I;
8183
8184 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8185 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8186 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8187 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8188 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8189 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8190 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8191 default: break;
8192 case Instruction::Add:
8193 case Instruction::Sub:
8194 case Instruction::Mul:
8195 case Instruction::FDiv:
8196 case Instruction::FRem:
8197 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8198 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8199 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8200 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8201 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8202 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8203 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8204 // the cast, do this xform.
8205 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8206 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8207 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8208 CI.getType(), CI);
8209 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8210 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008211 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008212 }
8213 }
8214 break;
8215 }
8216 }
8217 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008218}
8219
8220Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8221 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8222}
8223
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008224Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008225 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8226 if (OpI == 0)
8227 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8228
8229 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8230 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8231 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8232 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8233 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8234 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8235 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8236 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8237 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8238 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8239 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008240
8241 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008242}
8243
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008244Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008245 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8246 if (OpI == 0)
8247 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8248
8249 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8250 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8251 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8252 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8253 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8254 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8255 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8256 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8257 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8258 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008260
8261 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008262}
8263
8264Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8265 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8266}
8267
8268Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8269 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8270}
8271
8272Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008273 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008274}
8275
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008276Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8277 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8278 return I;
8279
8280 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8281 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8282
8283 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8284 ConstantInt *Cst;
8285 Value *X;
8286 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8287 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8288 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8289 // is a single-index GEP.
8290 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8291 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008292 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008293
8294 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8295 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8296 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8297
8298 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8299 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8300 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008301 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008302 }
8303 }
8304 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8305 // struct etc.
8306 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8307 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8308 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8309 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8310
8311 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8312 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8313
8314 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8315 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8316 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8317
8318 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8319 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8320 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8321
8322 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8323 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008324 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008325 }
8326 }
8327 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008328}
8329
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008330Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008331 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8332 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8333 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8334 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8335 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8336
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008337 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008338 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8339 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008340 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8341 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8342 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008343 } else {
8344 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8345 return Result;
8346 }
8347
8348
8349 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8350 // be replaced by the operand.
8351 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8353
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008354 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008355 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8356 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8357 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8358
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008359 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8360 // required for changing types.
8361 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8362 return 0;
8363
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008364 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8365 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8366 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8367 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8368 return V;
8369
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008370 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8371 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008372 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8373 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8374 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8375 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8376 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8377 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8378 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8379 ++NumZeros;
8380 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008381
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008382 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8383 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8384 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008385 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8386 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008387 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008388 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008389
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008390 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8391 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8392 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8393 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008394 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008395 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8396 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8397 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8398 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008399 CastInst *Tmp;
8400 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8401 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8402 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8403 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8404 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8405 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8406 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008407 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8408 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8409 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8410 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008411 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8412 // know the vector types match #elts.
8413 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008414 }
8415 }
8416 }
8417 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008418 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008419}
8420
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008421/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8422/// %C = or %A, %B
8423/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8424/// into:
8425/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8426/// %D = or %A, %C
8427///
8428/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8429/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8430/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8431///
8432static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8433 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8434 case Instruction::Add:
8435 case Instruction::Mul:
8436 case Instruction::And:
8437 case Instruction::Or:
8438 case Instruction::Xor:
8439 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8440 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8441 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008442 case Instruction::LShr:
8443 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008444 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008445 default:
8446 return 0; // Cannot fold
8447 }
8448}
8449
8450/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8451/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8452static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8453 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8454 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8455 case Instruction::Add:
8456 case Instruction::Sub:
8457 case Instruction::Or:
8458 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008459 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008460 case Instruction::LShr:
8461 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008462 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008463 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008464 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008465 case Instruction::Mul:
8466 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8467 }
8468}
8469
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008470/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8471/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8472Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8473 Instruction *FI) {
8474 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8475 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8476 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008477 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008478 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8479 return 0;
8480 } else {
8481 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8482 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008483
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008484 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008485 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8486 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008487 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008488 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008489 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008490 }
8491
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008492 // Only handle binary operators here.
8493 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008494 return 0;
8495
8496 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8497 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8498 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8499 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8500 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8501 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8502 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8503 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8504 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8505 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8506 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8507 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8508 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8509 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8510 return 0;
8511 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8512 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8513 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8514 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8515 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8516 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8517 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8518 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8519 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8520 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8521 } else {
8522 return 0;
8523 }
8524
8525 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008526 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8527 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008528 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8529
8530 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8531 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008532 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008533 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008534 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008535 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008536 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8537 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008538}
8539
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008540/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8541/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8542///
8543Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8544 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8545 bool Changed = false;
8546 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8547 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8548 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8549 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8550 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8551
8552 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8553 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8554 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8555 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008556 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008557 switch (Pred) {
8558 default: break;
8559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8561 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8562 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8564 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8565 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8566 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8567 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8568 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8569 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8570 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8571 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8572 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8573 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8574 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8575 Changed = true;
8576 }
8577 break;
8578 }
8579 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8581 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8582 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8584 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8585 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8586 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8587 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8588 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8589 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8590 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8591 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8592 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8593 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8594 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8595 Changed = true;
8596 }
8597 break;
8598 }
8599 }
8600
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008601 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8602 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
8603 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8604 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(0)) &&
8605 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)))
8606 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8607 else if (!match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt(-1)) ||
8608 !match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt(0)))
8609 Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
8610 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8611 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8612 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8613 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8614 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8615
8616 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8617 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8618 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8619 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8620 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8621 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8622 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8623 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8624 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8625 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008626 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8627 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008628 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8629
8630 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8631 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8632 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8633
8634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8635 }
8636 }
8637 }
8638
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008639 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8640 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8641 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8643 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8644 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8646 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8647
8648 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8649 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8650 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8652 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8653 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8655 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8656 }
8657
8658 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8659
8660 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8661}
8662
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008663Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008664 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8665 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8666 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8667
8668 // select true, X, Y -> X
8669 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008670 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008672
8673 // select C, X, X -> X
8674 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8676
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008677 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8679 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8680 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8681 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8682 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8683 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8684 else
8685 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8686 }
8687
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008688 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008689 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008690 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008691 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008692 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008693 } else {
8694 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8695 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008696 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008697 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008698 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008699 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008700 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008701 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008702 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008703 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008704 } else {
8705 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8706 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008707 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008708 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008709 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008710 }
8711 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008712
8713 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8714 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8715 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008716 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008717 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008718 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008719 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008720
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008721 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8722 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8723 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008724 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008725 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008726 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008727 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008728 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008729 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008730 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008731 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008732 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008733 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008734
8735 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008736
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008737 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008738
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008739 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008740 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008741 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008742 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008743 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008744 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008745 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008746 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008747 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008748 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008749 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008750 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8751
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008752 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8753 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8754 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008755 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8756 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757 if (SRASize < SISize)
8758 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8759 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8760 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008761 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008762 }
8763 }
8764
8765
8766 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008767 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008768 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8769 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008770 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008771 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008772 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8773 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8774 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008775 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8776 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8777 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008778 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8779 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008780 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8781 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008782 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008783 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008784 Value *V = ICA;
8785 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008786 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008787 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8789 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008790 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008791 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008792
8793 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008794 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8795 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008796 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008797 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8798 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8799 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8800 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8801 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8802 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8803 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8804 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8805 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008807 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008808 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008809 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008811 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008812
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008813 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008814 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008815 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8816 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8817 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8818 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8819 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8820 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8821 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8822 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8823 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8824 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8825 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008826 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008827 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008829 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008830 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008831 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008832 }
8833
8834 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008835 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8836 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8837 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008838
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008839 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8840 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8841 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008842 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8843
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008844 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8845 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8846 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8847 return IV;
8848
8849 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8850 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008851 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8852 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8853 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8854 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8855 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8856 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8857 }
8858
8859 if (AddOp) {
8860 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8861 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8862 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8863 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8864 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8865 }
8866
8867 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008868 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8869 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8870 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8871 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8872 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8873 } else {
8874 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008875 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008876 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008877
8878 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8879 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8880 if (AddOp != TI)
8881 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8882 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008883 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8884 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008885
8886 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008887 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008888 }
8889 }
8890 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008891
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008892 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008893 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008894 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8895 // transformation we are doing here.
8896 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8897 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8898 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8899 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8900 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8901 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8902 OpToFold = 1;
8903 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8904 OpToFold = 2;
8905 }
8906
8907 if (OpToFold) {
8908 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008909 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008910 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8911 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008912 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008913 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008914 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008915 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008916 else {
8917 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8918 }
8919 }
8920 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008921
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008922 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8923 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8924 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8925 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8926 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8927 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8928 OpToFold = 1;
8929 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8930 OpToFold = 2;
8931 }
8932
8933 if (OpToFold) {
8934 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008935 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008936 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8937 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008938 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008939 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008940 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008941 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008942 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008943 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008944 }
8945 }
8946 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008947
8948 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8949 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8950 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8951 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8952 return &SI;
8953 }
8954
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008955 return 0;
8956}
8957
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008958/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8959/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8960/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8961/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8962/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8963///
8964static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8965 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008966
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008967 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8968 if (!U) return Align;
8969
8970 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8971 default: break;
8972 case Instruction::BitCast:
8973 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8974 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008975 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8976 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008977 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008978 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8979 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008980 AllZeroOperands = false;
8981 break;
8982 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008983
8984 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8985 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008986 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008987 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008988 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008989 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008990 }
8991
8992 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8993 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8994 // of the global.
8995 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8996 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8997 Align = PrefAlign;
8998 }
8999 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
9000 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
9001 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
9002 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
9003 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9004 Align = PrefAlign;
9005 }
9006 }
9007
9008 return Align;
9009}
9010
9011/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9012/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9013/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9014/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9015unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9016 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9017 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9018 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9019 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9020 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9021 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9022 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9023 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9024
9025 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9026 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9027
9028 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9029 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009030}
9031
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009032Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009033 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9034 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009035 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9036 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9037
9038 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9039 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9040 return MI;
9041 }
9042
9043 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9044 // load/store.
9045 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9046 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9047
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009048 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9049 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9050 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9051 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009052 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009053 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9054
9055 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009056 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009057
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009058 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009059 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009060
9061 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9062 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9063 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9064 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9065 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9066 // integer datatype.
9067 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9068 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9069 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9070 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9071 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009072 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009073 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9074 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9075 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9076 else
9077 break;
9078 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9079 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9080 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9081 else
9082 break;
9083 } else
9084 break;
9085 }
9086
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009087 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009088 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9089 }
9090 }
9091
9092
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009093 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9094 // infer, use it.
9095 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9096 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9097
9098 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9099 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009100 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9101 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9102 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9103
9104 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9105 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9106 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009107}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009108
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009109Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9110 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9111 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9112 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9113 return MI;
9114 }
9115
9116 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9117 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9118 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9119 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9120 return 0;
9121 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9122 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9123
9124 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9125 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9126
9127 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9128 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9129 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9130
9131 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9132 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9133
9134 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9135 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9136
9137 // Extract the fill value and store.
9138 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9139 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9140 Alignment), *MI);
9141
9142 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9143 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9144 return MI;
9145 }
9146
9147 return 0;
9148}
9149
9150
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009151/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9152/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9153/// the heavy lifting.
9154///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009155Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009156 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9157 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9158
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009159 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9160 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009161 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009162 bool Changed = false;
9163
9164 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9165 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9166 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9167
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009168 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009169 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009170 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9171 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9172 // alignment is sufficient.
9173 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009174 }
9175
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009176 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9177 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9178 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009179 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009180 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9181 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9182 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009183 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9184 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9185 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009186 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009187 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9188 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009189 Changed = true;
9190 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009191
9192 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9193 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9194 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009195 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009196
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009197 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9198 // set, update the alignment.
9199 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009200 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9201 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009202 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9203 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9204 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009205 }
9206
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009207 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009208 }
9209
9210 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9211 default: break;
9212 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9213 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9214 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9215 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9217 break;
9218 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9219 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9220 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9221 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9222 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9223 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9224 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9225 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9226 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9227 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9228 CI);
9229 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009230 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009231 break;
9232 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9233 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9234 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9235 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9236 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9237 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9238 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9239 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9240 }
9241 break;
9242 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9243 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9244 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009245 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9246 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9247 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9248 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9249 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9250 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9251 }
9252 break;
9253
9254 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9255 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9256 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9257 uint64_t UndefElts;
9258 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9259 UndefElts)) {
9260 II->setOperand(1, V);
9261 return II;
9262 }
9263 break;
9264 }
9265
9266 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9267 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9268 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9269 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009270
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009271 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9272 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9273 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9274 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9275 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9276 AllEltsOk = false;
9277 break;
9278 }
9279 }
9280
9281 if (AllEltsOk) {
9282 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9283 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9284 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9285 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009286
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009287 // Only extract each element once.
9288 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9289 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9290
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009291 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009292 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9293 continue;
9294 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9295 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9296
9297 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9298 Instruction *Elt =
9299 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9300 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9301 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009302 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009303
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009304 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9305 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9306 i, "tmp");
9307 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009308 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009309 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009310 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009311 }
9312 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009313
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009314 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9315 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9316 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9317 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9318 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9319 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9320 if (&*++BI == II)
9321 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009322 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009323 }
9324
9325 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9326 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9327 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9328 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9329 bool CannotRemove = false;
9330 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9331 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9332 CannotRemove = true;
9333 break;
9334 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009335 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9336 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9337 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9338 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9339 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9340 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9341 } else {
9342 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9343 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009344 CannotRemove = true;
9345 break;
9346 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009347 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009348 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009349
9350 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9351 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9352 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9353 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9354 break;
9355 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009356 }
9357
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009358 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009359}
9360
9361// InvokeInst simplification
9362//
9363Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009364 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009365}
9366
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009367/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9368/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009369static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9370 const CastInst * const CI,
9371 const TargetData * const TD,
9372 const int ix) {
9373 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9374 return false;
9375
9376 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9377 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9378 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009379 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009380 return true;
9381
9382 const Type* SrcTy =
9383 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9384 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9385 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9386 return false;
9387 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9388 return false;
9389 return true;
9390}
9391
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009392// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9393//
9394Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009395 bool Changed = false;
9396
9397 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9398 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009399 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9400
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009401 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009402
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009403 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9404 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9405 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9406 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9407 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009408 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009409 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9410 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009411 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9412 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9413 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9414 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9415 return 0;
9416 }
9417
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009418 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9419 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9420 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9421 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009422 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009423 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009424 CS.getInstruction());
9425
9426 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9427 CS.getInstruction()->
9428 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9429
9430 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9431 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009432 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9433 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009434 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009435 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9436 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009437
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009438 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9439 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9440 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9441 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9442
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009443 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9444 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9445 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009446 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009447 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9448 // the call.
9449 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009450 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9451 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9452 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9453 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9454 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009455 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009456 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009457 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009458
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009459 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009460 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009461 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009462 Changed = true;
9463 }
9464
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009465 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009466}
9467
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009468// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9469// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9470//
9471bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9472 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9473 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009474 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9475 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009476 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009477 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009478 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009479 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009480
9481 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9482 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9483 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9484 //
9485 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9486 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009487 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009488
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009489 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009490 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9491
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009492 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009493 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009494 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009495 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9496 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9497 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009498 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009499 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009500
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009501 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009502 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009503 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009504 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9505
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009506 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009507 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009508 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009509 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9510 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009511
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009512 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9513 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9514 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9515 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9516 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9517 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9518 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9519 UI != E; ++UI)
9520 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9521 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009522 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009523 return false;
9524 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009525
9526 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9527 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009528
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009529 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9530 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9531 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009532 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009533
9534 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009535 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9536
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009537 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9538 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009539 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009540
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009541 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9542 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009543 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009544 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9545 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009546 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009547 }
9548
9549 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009550 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009551 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009552
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009553 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9554 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009555 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009556 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9557 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009558 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9559 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009560 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009561 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009562 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009563 return false;
9564 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009565
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009566 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9567 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9568 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9569 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009570 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009571 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9572
9573 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009574 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009575
9576 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9577 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009578 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009579
9580 // Add the new return attributes.
9581 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009582 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009583
9584 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9585 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9586 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9587 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9588 Args.push_back(*AI);
9589 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009590 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009591 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009592 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009593 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009594 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009595
9596 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009597 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009598 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009599 }
9600
9601 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9602 // now...
9603 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9604 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9605
9606 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009607 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009608 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009609 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9610 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009611 } else {
9612 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9613 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9614 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9615 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9616 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009617 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9618 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009619 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009620 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9621 Args.push_back(Cast);
9622 } else {
9623 Args.push_back(*AI);
9624 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009625
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009626 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009627 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009628 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009629 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009630 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009631 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009632
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009633 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9634 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9635
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009636 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009637 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009638
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009639 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009640
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009641 Instruction *NC;
9642 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009643 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009644 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9645 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009646 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009647 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009648 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009649 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9650 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009651 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9652 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009653 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009654 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009655 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009656 }
9657
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009658 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009659 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009660 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009661 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009662 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009663 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009664 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009665
9666 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9667 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9668 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009669 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009670 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9671 } else {
9672 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9673 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9674 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009675 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009676 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009677 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009678 }
9679 }
9680
9681 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9682 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009683 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009684 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009685 return true;
9686}
9687
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009688// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9689// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9690//
9691Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9692 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9693 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9694 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009695 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009696
9697 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9698 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009699 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009700 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009701
9702 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9703 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9704
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009705 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009706 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9707 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9708
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009709 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009710 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009711 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9712 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009713 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009714
9715 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9716 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9717 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009718 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009719 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9720 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009721 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009722 break;
9723 }
9724
9725 if (NestTy) {
9726 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9727 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9728 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9729
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009730 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009731 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009732
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009733 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009734 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9735
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009736 // Add any result attributes.
9737 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009738 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009739
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009740 {
9741 unsigned Idx = 1;
9742 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9743 do {
9744 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009745 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009746 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9747 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9748 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9749 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009750 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009751 }
9752
9753 if (I == E)
9754 break;
9755
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009756 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009757 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009758 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009759 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009760 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009761
9762 ++Idx, ++I;
9763 } while (1);
9764 }
9765
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009766 // Add any function attributes.
9767 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9768 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9769
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009770 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9771 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009772 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009773
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009774 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009775 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9776
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009777 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009778 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009779 {
9780 unsigned Idx = 1;
9781 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9782 E = FTy->param_end();
9783
9784 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009785 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9786 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009787 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009788
9789 if (I == E)
9790 break;
9791
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009792 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009793 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009794
9795 ++Idx, ++I;
9796 } while (1);
9797 }
9798
9799 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9800 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9801 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009802 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009803 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9804 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009805 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009806
9807 Instruction *NewCaller;
9808 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009809 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9810 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9811 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9812 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009813 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009814 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009815 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009816 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9817 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009818 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9819 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9820 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9821 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009822 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009823 }
9824 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9825 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9826 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9827 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9828 return 0;
9829 }
9830 }
9831
9832 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9833 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9834 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9835 Constant *NewCallee =
9836 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9837 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9838 return CS.getInstruction();
9839}
9840
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009841/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9842/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9843/// and a single binop.
9844Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9845 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009846 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9847 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009848 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009849 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9850 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9851
9852 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9853 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009854
9855 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9856 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009857 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009858 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009859 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009860 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009861 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9862 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9863 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009864 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009865
9866 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9867 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9868 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9869 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9870 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009871
9872 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9873 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9874 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009875 }
9876
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009877 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9878
9879 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9880 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9881 // hide them behind a phi.
9882 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9883 return 0;
9884
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009885 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009886 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009887 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009888 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009889 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9890 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009891 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9892 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009893 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9894 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9895 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009896
9897 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009898 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9899 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009900 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9901 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009902 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9903 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9904 }
9905
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009906 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9907 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9908 if (NewLHS) {
9909 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9910 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9911 }
9912 if (NewRHS) {
9913 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9914 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9915 }
9916 }
9917
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009918 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009919 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009920 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009921 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009922 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009923 else {
9924 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009925 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009926 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009927}
9928
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009929/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9930/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9931/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9932/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009933///
9934/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9935/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9936/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009937static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9938 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9939
9940 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9941 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9942 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009943
9944 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9945 // profitable to do this xform.
9946 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9947 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9948 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9949 UI != E; ++UI) {
9950 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9951 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9952 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9953 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9954 }
9955 isAddressTaken = true;
9956 break;
9957 }
9958
9959 if (!isAddressTaken)
9960 return false;
9961 }
9962
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009963 return true;
9964}
9965
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009966
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009967// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9968// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9969// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9970Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9971 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9972
9973 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9974 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9975 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9976 // code size and simplifying code.
9977 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9978 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009979 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009980 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9981 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009982 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009983 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9984 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009985 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009986 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9987 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009988 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9989 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9990 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9991 // load and the PHI.
9992 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9993 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9994 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009995
9996 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9997 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9998 // the path through the other successor.
9999 if (isVolatile &&
10000 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10001 return 0;
10002
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010003 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010004 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010005 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
10006 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
10007 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010008 } else {
10009 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10010 }
10011
10012 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10013 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10014 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10015 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010016 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010017 return 0;
10018 if (CastSrcTy) {
10019 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10020 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010021 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010022 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10023 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010024 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10025 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
10026 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10027 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010028
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010029 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10030 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10031 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010032 if (isVolatile &&
10033 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10034 return 0;
10035
10036
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010037 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10038 return 0;
10039 }
10040 }
10041
10042 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10043 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010044 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10045 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010046 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010047
10048 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10049 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010050
10051 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010052 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10053 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10054 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10055 InVal = 0;
10056 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10057 }
10058
10059 Value *PhiVal;
10060 if (InVal) {
10061 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10062 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10063 PhiVal = InVal;
10064 delete NewPN;
10065 } else {
10066 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10067 PhiVal = NewPN;
10068 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010069
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010070 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010071 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010072 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010073 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010074 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010075 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010076 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010077 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010078 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10079
10080 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10081 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10082 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10083 if (isVolatile)
10084 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10085 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10086
10087 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010088}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010089
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010090/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10091/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010092static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10093 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010094 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10095 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10096
10097 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010098 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010099 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010100
10101 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10102 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10103 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010104
10105 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10106 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010107
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010108 return false;
10109}
10110
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010111/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10112/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10113/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10114static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10115 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10116 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10117 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10118 return true;
10119
10120 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10121 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10122 return false;
10123
10124 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10125 // the value.
10126 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10127 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10128 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10129 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10130 return false;
10131 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10132 return false;
10133 }
10134
10135 return true;
10136}
10137
10138
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010139// PHINode simplification
10140//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010141Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010142 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010143 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010144
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010145 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10147
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010148 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10149 // reducing code size.
10150 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10151 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10152 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10153 return Result;
10154
10155 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10156 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10157 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010158 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10159 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10160 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010161 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010162 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10163 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10165 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010166
10167 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10168 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10169 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10170 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10171 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10172 // late.
10173 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10174 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10175 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10177 }
10178 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010179
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010180 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10181 // same value, for example:
10182 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10183 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10184 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10185 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10186 {
10187 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10188 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10189 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10190 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10191 ++InValNo;
10192
10193 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10194 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10195
10196 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10197 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10198 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10199 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10200 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10201 break;
10202 }
10203
10204 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10205 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10206 // the value.
10207 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10208 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10209 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10210 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10211 }
10212 }
10213 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010214 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010215}
10216
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010217static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10218 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10219 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010220 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10221 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010222 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10223 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10224 // used for address computation.
10225 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10226 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10227 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10228 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010229}
10230
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010231
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010232Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010233 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010234 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010235 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010236 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010238
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010239 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10240 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10241
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010242 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10243 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10244 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10245
10246 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010248
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010249 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10250 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010251
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010252 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010253 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10254 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010255 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010256 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010257 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10258 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10259 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10260 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10261 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10262 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10263 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010264 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010265 }
10266 }
10267 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010268 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010269 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10270 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010271 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10272 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010273 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010274 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010275 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010276 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010277 MadeChange = true;
10278 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010279 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10280 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010281 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010282 MadeChange = true;
10283 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010284 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10285 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10286 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10287 MadeChange = true;
10288 } else {
10289 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10290 GEP);
10291 *i = Op;
10292 MadeChange = true;
10293 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010294 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010295 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010296 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010297 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10298
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010299 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10300 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10301 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010302 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10303 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10304 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10305 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10306 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10307 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010308 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10309 if (I != BCI) {
10310 I->takeName(BCI);
10311 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10312 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10313 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010314 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010315 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010316 }
10317 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10318 }
10319 }
10320
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010321 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10322 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10323 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10324 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010325 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010326 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010327 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010328
10329 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010330 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10331 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10332 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10333 //
10334 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10335 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10336 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10337
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010338 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010339
10340 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10341 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10342 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10343 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010344 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010345
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010346 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010347 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010348 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10349 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10350 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010351 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010352 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10353 Sum = GO1;
10354 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10355 Sum = SO1;
10356 } else {
10357 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10358 // target's pointer size.
10359 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10360 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010361 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010362 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010363 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010364 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010365 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10366 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010367 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010368 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010369
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010370 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010371 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010372 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010373 } else {
10374 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010375 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10376 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010377 }
10378 }
10379 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010380 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10381 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10382 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010383 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010384 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010385 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010386 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010387
10388 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10389 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10390 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10391 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10392 return &GEP;
10393 } else {
10394 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10395 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10396 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10397 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10398 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010399 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010400 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010401 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010402 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010403 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10404 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010405 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10406 }
10407
10408 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010409 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10410 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010411
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010412 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010413 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10414 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10415
10416 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010417 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010418 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10419 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10420 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10421
10422 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010423 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10424 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010425
10426 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10427 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10428 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010429 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010430 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10431 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10432 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010433 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10434 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010435 //
10436 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10437 //
10438 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10439 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10440 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10441 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10442 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10443 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10444 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10445 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10446 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10447 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10448 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10449 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10450 return &GEP;
10451 }
10452 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10453 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010454 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10455 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010456 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10457 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10458 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010459 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10460 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010461 Value *Idx[2];
10462 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10463 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010464 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010465 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010466 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10467 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010468 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010469
10470 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010471 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010472 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010473 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010474
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010475 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010476 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010477 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010478
10479 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10480 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10481 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10482 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10483 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10484 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10485 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10486 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010487 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010488 Scale = CI;
10489 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10490 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10491 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010492 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10493 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10494 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010495 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10496 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10497 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10498 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10499 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10500 }
10501 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010502
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010503 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010504 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10505 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10506 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10507 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10508 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10509 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10510 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010511 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010512 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010513 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010514 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010515 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10516 }
10517
10518 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010519 Value *Idx[2];
10520 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10521 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010522 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010523 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010524 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10525 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10526 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010527 }
10528 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010529 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010530 }
10531
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010532 return 0;
10533}
10534
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010535Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10536 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010537 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010538 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10539 const Type *NewTy =
10540 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010541 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010542
10543 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10544 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010545 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010546 else {
10547 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010548 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010549 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010550
10551 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010552
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010553 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10554 // allocas if possible...
10555 //
10556 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10557 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10558
10559 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10560 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10561 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010562 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010563 Value *Idx[2];
10564 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10565 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010566 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10567 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010568
10569 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10570 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010572 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10573 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010574 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010575 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010576
10577 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10578 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10579 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010580 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010581 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10583
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010584 return 0;
10585}
10586
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010587Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10588 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10589
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010590 // free undef -> unreachable.
10591 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10592 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010593 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010594 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010595 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10596 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010597
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010598 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10599 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010600 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010601 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010602
10603 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10604 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10605 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10606 return &FI;
10607 }
10608
10609 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10610 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10611 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10612 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10613 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10614 return &FI;
10615 }
10616 }
10617
10618 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10619 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10620 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10621 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10622 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10623 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010624
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010625 return 0;
10626}
10627
10628
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010629/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010630static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010631 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010632 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010633 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010634
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010635 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10636 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10637 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010638 std::string Str;
10639 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010640 unsigned len = Str.length();
10641 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10642 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10643 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10644 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010645 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10646 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10647 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10648 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10649 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10650 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10651 }
10652 } else {
10653 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10654 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10655 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10656 }
10657 // Append NULL at the end.
10658 SingleChar = 0;
10659 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10660 }
10661 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10662 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010663 }
10664 }
10665 }
10666
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010667 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010668 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010669 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010670
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010671 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010672 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010673 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10674 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10675 // constants.
10676 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10677 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10678 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010679 Value *Idxs[2];
10680 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10681 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010682 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10683 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10684 }
10685
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010686 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010687 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010688 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10689 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10690 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010691 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10692 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010693
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010694 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10695 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10696 // the result of the loaded value.
10697 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10698 CI->getName(),
10699 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10700 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010701 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010702 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010703 }
10704 }
10705 return 0;
10706}
10707
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010708/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010709/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10710/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10711/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10712static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010713 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10714 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10715
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010716 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010717 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010718 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010719 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010720
10721 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10722 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010723 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10724 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10725 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010726 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10727
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010728 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010729 --BBI;
10730
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010731 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10732 // marked invalid.
10733 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10734 return false;
10735
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010736 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10737 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010738 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010739 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010740 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010741
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010742 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010743 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010744}
10745
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010746/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10747/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10748/// value in code like this:
10749/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10750/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10751/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10752/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10753///
10754static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10755 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10756 if (A == B) return true;
10757
10758 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10759 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10760 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10761 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10762 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10763 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10764 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10765 return true;
10766
10767 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10768 return false;
10769}
10770
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010771Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10772 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010773
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010774 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010775 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10776 if (KnownAlign >
10777 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10778 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010779 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10780
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010781 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010782 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010783 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010784 return Res;
10785
10786 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10787 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010788
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010789 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10790 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10791 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10792 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10793 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10794 --ScanInsts) {
10795 --BBI;
10796
10797 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10798 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010800 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10801 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010803 }
10804
10805 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10806 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10807 break;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010808 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010809
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010810 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10811 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10812 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10813 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10814 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010815 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10816 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10817 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10818 // CFG.
10819 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10820 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10822 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010823 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010824
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010825 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010826 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010827 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10828 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10829 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010830 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10831 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10832 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010833 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10834 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010836 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010837
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010838 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10839 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010840 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010841 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010842
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010843 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010844 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010845 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10846 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010847 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010848 if (Constant *V =
10849 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010851 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10852 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10853 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10854 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10855 // CFG.
10856 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10857 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10858 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10859 }
10860
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010861 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010862 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010863 return Res;
10864 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010865 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010866 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010867
10868 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10869 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010870 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010871 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10872 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10874 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10876 }
10877 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010878
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010879 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010880 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10881 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10882 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10883 //
10884 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10885 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10886 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10887 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10888 // unconditionally.
10889 //
10890 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10891 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010892 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10893 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010894 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010895 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010896 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010897 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010898 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010899 }
10900
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010901 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10902 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10903 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10904 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10905 return &LI;
10906 }
10907
10908 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10909 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10910 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10911 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10912 return &LI;
10913 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010914 }
10915 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010916 return 0;
10917}
10918
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010919/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010920/// when possible.
10921static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10922 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10923 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10924
10925 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10926 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10927 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10928
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010929 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010930 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10931 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10932 // constants.
10933 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10934 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10935 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010936 Value* Idxs[2];
10937 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10938 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010939 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10940 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10941 }
10942
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010943 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10944 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10945 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010946
10947 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010948 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10949 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010950 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010951 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010952 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10953 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10954 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10955 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10956 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010957 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010958 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010959 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010960 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10961 }
10962 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010963 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010964 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010965 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010966 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010967 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010968 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10969 }
10970 }
10971 }
10972 return 0;
10973}
10974
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010975Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10976 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10977 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10978
10979 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010980 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010981 ++NumCombined;
10982 return 0;
10983 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010984
10985 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10986 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010987 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010988 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10989 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10990 ++NumCombined;
10991 return 0;
10992 }
10993
10994 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10995 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10996 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10997 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10998 ++NumCombined;
10999 return 0;
11000 }
11001 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011002
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011003 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000011004 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
11005 if (KnownAlign >
11006 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11007 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011008 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11009
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011010 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
11011 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11012 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11013 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11014 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11015 --ScanInsts) {
11016 --BBI;
11017
11018 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11019 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011020 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11021 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011022 ++NumDeadStore;
11023 ++BBI;
11024 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11025 continue;
11026 }
11027 break;
11028 }
11029
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011030 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11031 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11032 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11033 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011034 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11035 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011036 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11037 ++NumCombined;
11038 return 0;
11039 }
11040 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11041 // may not be dead.
11042 break;
11043 }
11044
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011045 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011046 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011047 break;
11048 }
11049
11050
11051 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011052
11053 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11054 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11055 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11056 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11057 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011058 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011059 ++NumCombined;
11060 }
11061 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11062 }
11063
11064 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11065 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011066 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011067 ++NumCombined;
11068 return 0;
11069 }
11070
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011071 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11072 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011073 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011074 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11075 return Res;
11076 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011077 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011078 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11079 return Res;
11080
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011081
11082 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11083 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011084 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011085 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011086 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11087 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11088 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011089
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011090 return 0;
11091}
11092
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011093/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11094/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11095/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11096///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011097/// Simplify things like:
11098/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11099/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11100///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011101bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11102 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11103
11104 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11105 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11106 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011107 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011108
11109 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11110 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011111 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11112 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011113 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011114 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011115 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011116 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011117 return false;
11118
11119 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011120 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011121 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011122 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011123 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011124 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011125 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011126
11127 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11128 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11129 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11130 return false;
11131
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011132 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11133 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011134 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011135 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011136 return false;
11137
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011138 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11139 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11140 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11141 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11142 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11143 --BBI;
11144 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11145 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11146 return false;
11147 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011148 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011149 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11150 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11151 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11152 return false;
11153
11154 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011155 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11156 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011157 for (;; --BBI) {
11158 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11159 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11160 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11161 return false;
11162 break;
11163 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011164 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11165 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11166 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011167 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11168 return false;
11169 }
11170
11171 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011172 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11173 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011174 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11175 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011176 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011177 return false;
11178 }
11179 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011180
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011181 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011182 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11183 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011184 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011185 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11186 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011187 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11188 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011189 }
11190
11191 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11192 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011193 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011194 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11195 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11196
11197 // Nuke the old stores.
11198 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11199 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11200 ++NumCombined;
11201 return true;
11202}
11203
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011204
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011205Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11206 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011207 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011208 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11209 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11210 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11211 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11212 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11213 BI.setCondition(X);
11214 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11215 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11216 return &BI;
11217 }
11218
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011219 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11220 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11221 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11222 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11223 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11224 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11225 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011226 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011227 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11228 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011229 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11230 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11231 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11232 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011233 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011234 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011235 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011236 return &BI;
11237 }
11238
11239 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11240 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11241 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11242 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11243 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11244 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11245 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11246 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011247 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011248 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11249 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011250 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011251 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011252 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11253 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011254 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011255 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011256 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011257 return &BI;
11258 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011259
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011260 return 0;
11261}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011262
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011263Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11264 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11265 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11266 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11267 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11268 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11269 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011270 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011271 AddRHS));
11272 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011273 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011274 return &SI;
11275 }
11276 }
11277 return 0;
11278}
11279
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011280Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011281 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011282
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011283 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11285
11286 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11287 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11288 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11289
11290 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11291 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11292
11293 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11294 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11295 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11296 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11297 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11298 // first index
11299 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11300 else
11301 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11302 }
11303 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11304 }
11305 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11306 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11307 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11308 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11309 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11310 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11311 ++exti, ++insi) {
11312 if (*insi != *exti)
11313 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11314 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11315 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11316 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11317 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11318 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11319 // with
11320 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11321 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11322 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11323 }
11324 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11325 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11326 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11327 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11328 // with "i32 42"
11329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11330 if (exti == exte) {
11331 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11332 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11333 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11334 // with
11335 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11336 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11337 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11338 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11339 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11340 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11341 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11342 EV);
11343 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11344 insi, inse);
11345 }
11346 if (insi == inse)
11347 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11348 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11349 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11350 // i.e., replace
11351 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11352 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11353 // with
11354 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11355 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11356 exti, exte);
11357 }
11358 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11359 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11360 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11361 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011362 return 0;
11363}
11364
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011365/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11366/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11367static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11368 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11369 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011370 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011371 if (isConstant) return true;
11372 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11373 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11374 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11375 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11376 return false;
11377 return true;
11378 }
11379 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11380 if (!I) return false;
11381
11382 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11383 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11384 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11385 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11386 return true;
11387 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11388 return true;
11389 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11390 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11391 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11392 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11393 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011394 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11395 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11396 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11397 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11398 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011399
11400 return false;
11401}
11402
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011403/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11404///
11405/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11406/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011407static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11408 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11409 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11410 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11411 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11412 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11413
11414 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011415 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011416 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11417 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011418 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11419 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011420 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011421 return Result;
11422}
11423
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011424/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11425/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11426/// extracted from the vector.
11427static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011428 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11429 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011430 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11431 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011432 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11433
11434 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11435 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11436 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11437 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011438 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011439 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11440 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11441 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011442 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11443 return 0;
11444 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011445
11446 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11447 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011448 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11449 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011450
11451 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11452 // vector input.
11453 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011454 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011455 unsigned LHSWidth =
11456 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011457 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011458 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011459 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011460 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
11461 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011462 else
11463 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011464 }
11465
11466 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11467 return 0;
11468}
11469
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011470Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011471 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011472 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11474
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011475 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011476 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11478
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011479 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011480 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11481 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11482 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011483 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011484 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011485 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11486 op0 = 0;
11487 break;
11488 }
11489 if (op0)
11490 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011491 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011492
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011493 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11494 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011495 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011496 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11497 unsigned VectorWidth =
11498 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11499
11500 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11501 // crashing the code below.
11502 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11503 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11504
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011505 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11506 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11507 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011508 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011509 uint64_t UndefElts;
11510 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011511 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011512 UndefElts)) {
11513 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11514 return &EI;
11515 }
11516 }
11517
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011518 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011520
11521 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11522 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11523 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11524 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11525 if (const VectorType *VT =
11526 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11527 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11528 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11529 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11530 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011531 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011532
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011533 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011534 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11535 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11536 // profitable to do so
11537 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011538 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11539 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11540 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11541 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11542 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11543 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11544 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11545 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11546 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11547 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011548 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011549 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011550 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011551 unsigned AS =
11552 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011553 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11554 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011555 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11556 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011557 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11558 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011559 }
11560 }
11561 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11562 // Extracting the inserted element?
11563 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11565 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11566 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11567 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11568 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11569 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11570 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11571 return &EI;
11572 }
11573 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11574 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11575 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011576 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11577 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011578 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011579 unsigned LHSWidth =
11580 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11581
11582 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011583 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011584 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
11585 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011586 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11587 } else {
11588 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011589 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011590 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011591 }
11592 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011593 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011594 return 0;
11595}
11596
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011597/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11598/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11599/// Otherwise, return false.
11600static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11601 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11602 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11603 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011604 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011605
11606 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011607 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011608 return true;
11609 } else if (V == LHS) {
11610 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011611 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011612 return true;
11613 } else if (V == RHS) {
11614 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011615 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011616 return true;
11617 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11618 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11619 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11620 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11621 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11622
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011623 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11624 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011625 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011626
11627 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11628 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11629 // transitively ok.
11630 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11631 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011632 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011633 return true;
11634 }
11635 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11636 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011637 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11638 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011639 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011640
11641 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11642 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11643 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11644 // transitively ok.
11645 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11646 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11647 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011648 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011649 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011650 } else {
11651 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011652 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011653 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011654
11655 }
11656 return true;
11657 }
11658 }
11659 }
11660 }
11661 }
11662 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11663
11664 return false;
11665}
11666
11667/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11668/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11669/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011670static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011671 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011672 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011673 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011674 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011675 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011676
11677 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011678 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011679 return V;
11680 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011681 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011682 return V;
11683 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11684 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11685 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11686 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11687 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11688
11689 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11690 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11691 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11692 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011693 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11694 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011695
11696 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11697 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011698 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11699 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11700 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011701 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011702 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011703 return V;
11704 }
11705
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011706 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11707 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011708 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11709 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11710 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011711 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011712 }
11713 return V;
11714 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011715
11716 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11717 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11718 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11719 return EI->getOperand(0);
11720
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011721 }
11722 }
11723 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011724 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011725
11726 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11727 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011728 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011729 return V;
11730}
11731
11732Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11733 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11734 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11735 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11736
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011737 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11738 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11739 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11740
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011741 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11742 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11743 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11744 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11745 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11746 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011747 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11748 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011749 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011750
11751 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11753
11754 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11756
11757 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11758 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11759 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11761
11762 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11763 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11764 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11765 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11766 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11767 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11768 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11769 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11770 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11771 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011772 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011773 else {
11774 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011775 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011776 NumVectorElts));
11777 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011778 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011779 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011780 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011781 }
11782
11783 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11784 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11785 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11786 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011787 Value *RHS = 0;
11788 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11789 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11790 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011791 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011792 }
11793 }
11794 }
11795
11796 return 0;
11797}
11798
11799
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011800Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11801 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11802 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011803 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011804
11805 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011806
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011807 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011808 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011810
11811 uint64_t UndefElts;
11812 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011813
11814 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
11815 return 0;
11816
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011817 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11818 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011819 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11820 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11821 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011822 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011823 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011824
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011825 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11826 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11827 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11828 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011829 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11831 }
11832
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011833 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11834 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11835 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011836 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011837 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011838 else {
11839 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011840 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011841 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011842 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11843 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011844 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011845 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11846 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011847 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011848 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011849 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011850 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011851 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011852 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11853 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011854 MadeChange = true;
11855 }
11856
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011857 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011858 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011859
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011860 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11861 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11862 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11863 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11864
11865 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11866 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011867 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011868
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011869 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11870 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11871 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011872
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011873 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11874 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11875 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11876 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11877 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11878 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11879 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11880 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11881 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11882 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11883 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11884 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11885
11886 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11887 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11888 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11889 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11890 else
11891 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11892
11893 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11894 // the replacement.
11895 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11896 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11897 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11898 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011899 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011900 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011901 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011902 }
11903 }
11904 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11905 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011906 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011907 }
11908 }
11909 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011910
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011911 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11912}
11913
11914
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011915
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011916
11917/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11918/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11919/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11920/// end of its block.
11921static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11922 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11923
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011924 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011925 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11926 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011927
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011928 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011929 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11930 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011931 return false;
11932
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011933 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11934 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011935 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11936 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011937 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11938 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11939 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011940 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011941
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011942 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011943
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011944 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011945 ++NumSunkInst;
11946 return true;
11947}
11948
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011949
11950/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11951/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11952///
11953/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11954/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11955/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11956/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11957/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11958///
11959static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011960 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011961 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011962 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011963 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011964 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011965
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011966 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11967 BB = Worklist.back();
11968 Worklist.pop_back();
11969
11970 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11971 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11972
11973 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11974 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011975
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011976 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11977 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11978 ++NumDeadInst;
11979 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11980 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11981 continue;
11982 }
11983
11984 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11985 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11986 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11987 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11988 ++NumConstProp;
11989 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11990 continue;
11991 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011992
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011993 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011994 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011995
11996 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11997 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11998 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11999 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12000 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12001 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012002 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012003 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012004 continue;
12005 }
12006 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12007 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12008 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12009 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12010 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012011 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012012 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012013 continue;
12014 }
12015
12016 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12017 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12018 continue;
12019 }
12020 }
12021
12022 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12023 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012024 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012025}
12026
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012027bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012028 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012029 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012030
12031 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12032 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012033
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012034 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012035 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12036 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12037 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012038 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012039 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012040
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012041 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12042 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12043 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12044 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12045 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12046 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12047 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12048 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012049
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012050 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012051 ++NumDeadInst;
12052
12053 if (!I->use_empty())
12054 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12055 I->eraseFromParent();
12056 }
12057 }
12058 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012059
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012060 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12061 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12062 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012063
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012064 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012065 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012066 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012067 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012068 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012069 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012070
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012071 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012072
12073 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012074 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012075 continue;
12076 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012077
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012078 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000012079 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012080 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012081
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012082 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012083 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012084 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12085
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012086 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012087 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012088 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012089 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012090 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012091
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012092 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12093 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12094 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12095 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12096 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12097 i->set(NewC);
12098 }
12099 }
12100 }
12101
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012102 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012103 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012104 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12105 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12106 if (UserParent != BB) {
12107 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12108 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12109 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12110 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12111 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12112 break;
12113 }
12114
12115 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12116 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12117 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12118 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12119 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12120 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12121 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12122 }
12123 }
12124
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012125 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012126#ifndef NDEBUG
12127 std::string OrigI;
12128#endif
12129 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012130 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012131 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012132 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012133 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012134 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12135 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012136
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012137 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12138 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12139
12140 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012141 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012142 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012143
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012144 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12145 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012146
12147 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12148 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012149 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12150
12151 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12152 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12153 ++InsertPos;
12154
12155 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012156
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012157 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12158 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012159 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012160
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012161 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12162 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012163 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012164
12165 // Erase the old instruction.
12166 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012167 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012168#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012169 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12170 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012171#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012172
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012173 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12174 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012175 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12176 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12177 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012178 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012179
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012180 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012181 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012182 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012183 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012184 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012185 AddToWorkList(I);
12186 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012187 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012188 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012189 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012190 }
12191 }
12192
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012193 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012194
12195 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12196 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012197 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012198}
12199
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012200
12201bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012202 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12203
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012204 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12205
12206 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12207 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012208 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012209 EverMadeChange = true;
12210 return EverMadeChange;
12211}
12212
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012213FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012214 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012215}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012216
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012217